The Designer s Guide to Instrumentation Amplifiers pdf file of entire guide

A Designer’s Guide to
Instrumentation Amplifiers
3 RD Edition
www.analog.com/inamps
A DESIGNER’S GUIDE TO
INSTRUMENTATION AMPLIFIERS
3RD Edition
by
Charles Kitchin and Lew Counts
All rights reserved. This publication, or parts thereof, may not be
reproduced in any form without permission of the copyright owner.
Information furnished by Analog Devices, Inc. is believed to be
accurate and reliable. However, no responsibility is assumed by
Analog Devices, Inc. for its use.
Analog Devices, Inc. makes no representation that the interconnection of its circuits as described herein will not infringe on existing or
future patent rights, nor do the descriptions contained herein imply
the granting of licenses to make, use, or sell equipment constructed
in accordance therewith.
Specifications and prices are subject to change without notice.
©2006 Analog Devices, Inc. Printed in the U.S.A.
G02678-15-9/06(B)
ii
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER I—IN-AMP BASICS ............................................................................................................ 1-1
Introduction . .................................................................................................................................. 1-1
IN-AMPS vs. OP AMPS: WHAT ARE THE DIFFERENCES? ................................................................... 1-1
Signal Amplification and Common-Mode Rejection ................................................................................ 1-1
Common-Mode Rejection: Op Amp vs. In-Amp . .................................................................................... 1-3
Difference Amplifiers ................................................................................................................... 1-5
WHERE are in-amps and Difference amps used? .................................................................. 1-5
Data Acquisition .................................................................................................................................... 1-5
Medical Instrumentation ........................................................................................................................ 1-6
Monitor and Control Electronics ............................................................................................................ 1-6
Software-Programmable Applications ..................................................................................................... 1-6
Audio Applications . ............................................................................................................................... 1-6
High Speed Signal Conditioning . ........................................................................................................... 1-6
Video Applications ................................................................................................................................. 1-6
Power Control Applications .................................................................................................................... 1-6
IN-AMPS: AN EXTERNAL VIEW ............................................................................................................ 1-6
WHAT OTHER PROPERTIES DEFINE A HIGH QUALITY IN-AMP? . ................................................. 1-7
High AC (and DC) Common-Mode Rejection ........................................................................................ 1-7
Low Offset Voltage and Offset Voltage Drift ............................................................................................. 1-7
A Matched, High Input Impedance ........................................................................................................ 1-8
Low Input Bias and Offset Current Errors .............................................................................................. 1-8
Low Noise ............................................................................................................................................. 1-8
Low Nonlinearity ................................................................................................................................... 1-8
Simple Gain Selection ............................................................................................................................ 1-8
Adequate Bandwidth . ............................................................................................................................ 1-8
Differential to Single-Ended Conversion ................................................................................................. 1-9
Rail-to-Rail Input and Output Swing ...................................................................................................... 1-9
Power vs. Bandwidth, Slew Rate, and Noise ............................................................................................ 1-9
CHAPTER II—INSIDE AN INSTRUMENTATION AMPLIFIER . ...................................................... 2-1
A Simple Op Amp Subtractor Provides an In-Amp Function ................................................................... 2-1
Improving the Simple Subtractor with Input Buffering ............................................................................ 2-1
The 3-Op Amp In-Amp ......................................................................................................................... 2-2
3-Op Amp In-Amp Design Considerations . ............................................................................................ 2-3
The Basic 2-Op Amp Instrumentation Amplifier ..................................................................................... 2-4
2-Op Amp In-Amps­—Common-Mode Design Considerations for Single-Supply Operation ..................... 2-5
CHAPTER III—MONOLITHIC INSTRUMENTATION AMPLIFIERS .............................................. 3-1
Advantages Over Op Amp In-Amps ............................................................................................... 3-1
Which to Use—an In-Amp or a Diff Amp? .............................................................................................. 3-1
MONOLITHIC IN-AMP DESIGN—THE INSIDE STORY
High Performance In-Amps . .................................................................................................................. 3-2
Low Cost In-Amps ................................................................................................................................ 3-5
Pin-Programmable, Precise Gain In-Amps .............................................................................................. 3-6
Auto-Zeroing Instrumentation Amplifiers................................................................................................ 3-8
Fixed Gain (Low Drift) In-Amps .......................................................................................................... 3-16
Monolithic In-Amps Optimized for Single-Supply Operation ................................................................. 3-17
Low Power, Single-Supply In-Amps . .................................................................................................... 3-19
Gain-Programmable In-Amps .............................................................................................................. 3-20
CHAPTER IV—MONOLITHIC DIFFERENCE AMPLIFIERS ........................................................... 4-1
Difference (Subtractor) Amplifier Products ............................................................................................. 4-1
AD8205 Difference Amplifier ................................................................................................................. 4-3
iii
Gain Adjustment . .................................................................................................................................. 4-6
High Frequency Differential Receiver/Amplifiers ..................................................................................... 4-9
CHAPTER V—APPLYING IN-AMPS EFFECTIVELY ........................................................................ 5-1
Dual-Supply Operation .......................................................................................................................... 5-1
Single-Supply Operation ........................................................................................................................ 5-1
The Need for True R-R Devices in Low Voltage, Single-Supply IA Circuits .............................................. 5-1
Power Supply Bypassing, Decoupling, and Stability Issues ....................................................................... 5-1
THE IMPORTANCE OF AN INPUT GROUND RETURN ..................................................................... 5-2
Providing Adequate Input and Output Swing (“Headroom”) When AC Coupling a
Single-Supply In-Amp . ....................................................................................................................... 5-3
Selecting and Matching RC Coupling Components . ............................................................................... 5-3
Properly Driving an In-Amp’s Reference Input . ...................................................................................... 5-4
Cable Termination .......................................................................................................................... 5-5
Input Protection Basics For ADI In-Amps .............................................................................. 5-5
Input Protection from ESD and DC Overload . ....................................................................................... 5-5
Adding External Protection Diodes . ....................................................................................................... 5-8
ESD and Transient Overload Protection . ................................................................................................ 5-9
Design Issues Affecting DC Accuracy ................................................................................... 5-9
Designing for the Lowest Possible Offset Voltage Drift ............................................................................. 5-9
Designing for the Lowest Possible Gain Drift .......................................................................................... 5-9
Practical Solutions ............................................................................................................................... 5-11
Option 1: Use a Better Quality Gain Resistor . ........................................................................................... 5-11
Option 2: Use a Fixed-Gain In-Amp ........................................................................................................ 5-11
RTI AND RTO ERRORS ........................................................................................................................ 5-11
Offset Error . ......................................................................................................................................... 5-12
Noise Errors .......................................................................................................................................... 5-12
Reducing RFI Rectification Errors in In-Amp Circuits ................................................ 5-12
Designing Practical RFI Filters ............................................................................................................. 5-12
Selecting RFI Input Filter Component Values Using a Cookbook Approach ........................................... 5-14
Specific Design Examples . ................................................................................................................... 5-15
An RFI Circuit for AD620 Series In-Amps ............................................................................................... 5-15
An RFI Circuit for Micropower In-Amps . ................................................................................................. 5-15
An RFI Filter for the AD623 In-Amp . ..................................................................................................... 5-16
AD8225 RFI Filter Circuit ..................................................................................................................... 5-16
An RFI Filter For The AD8555 Sensor Amplifier .................................................................. 5-17
In-Amps with On-Chip EMI/RFI Filtering ........................................................................................... 5-17
Common-Mode Filters Using X2Y Capacitors ..................................................................................... 5-19
Using Common-Mode RF Chokes for In-Amp RFI Filters ........................................................................... 5-20
RFI TESTING ....................................................................................................................................... 5-21
USING LOW-PASS FILTERING TO IMPROVE SIGNAL-TO-NOISE RATIO ...................................... 5-21
EXTERNAL CMR AND SETTLING TIME ADJUSTMENTS . ............................................................. 5-23
CHAPTER VI—IN-AMP AND DIFF AMP APPLICATIONS CIRCUITS ........................................... 6-1
A True Differential Output In-Amp Circuit ............................................................................................. 6-1
DIFFERENCE AMPLIFIER MEASURES HIGH VOLTAGES . ................................................................ 6-1
Precision Current Source ....................................................................................................................... 6-3
Integrator for PID Loop ......................................................................................................................... 6-3
Composite In-Amp Circuit Has Excellent High Frequency CMR ............................................................ 6-3
Strain Gage Measurement Using An AC Excitation ......................................................... 6-5
Applications of the AD628 Precision Gain Block ............................................................... 6-6
Why Use a Gain Block IC? ..................................................................................................................... 6-6
Standard Differential Input ADC Buffer Circuit with Single-Pole LP Filter .............................................. 6-6
Changing the Output Scale Factor . ........................................................................................................ 6-7
iv
Using an External Resistor to Operate the AD628 at Gains Below 0.1 . .................................................... 6-7
Differential Input Circuit with 2-Pole Low-Pass Filtering ........................................................................ 6-8
Using the AD628 to Create Precision Gain Blocks .................................................................................. 6-9
Operating the AD628 as a +10 or –10 Precision Gain Block .................................................................... 6-9
Operating the AD628 at a Precision Gain of +11 . ................................................................................. 6-10
Operating the AD628 at a Precision Gain of +1 . ................................................................................... 6-10
Increased BW Gain Block of –9.91 Using Feedforward . ........................................................................ 6-11
CURRENT TRANSMITTER REJECTS GROUND NOISE ................................................................... 6-12
High Level ADC Interface .......................................................................................................... 6-13
A High Speed noninverting Summing Amplifier .............................................................. 6-15
High Voltage Monitor ................................................................................................................. 6-16
PRECISION 48 V BUS MONITOR . ....................................................................................................... 6-17
HIGH-SIDE CURRENT SENSE WITH A LOW-SIDE SWITCH ........................................................... 6-18
HIGH-SIDE CURRENT SENSE WITH A HIGH-SIDE SWITCH ......................................................... 6-19
Motor Control ..................................................................................................................................... 6-19
BRIDGE APPLICATIONS . .................................................................................................................... 6-19
A Classic Bridge Circuit ....................................................................................................................... 6-19
A Single-Supply Data Acquisition System ............................................................................................. 6-20
A Low Dropout Bipolar Bridge Driver .................................................................................................. 6-20
TRANSDUCER INTERFACE APPLICATIONS .................................................................................... 6-21
ELECTROCARDIOGRAM SIGNAL CONDITIONING ....................................................................... 6-21
REMOTE LOAD-SENSING TECHNIQUE . .......................................................................................... 6-24
A PRECISION VOLTAGE-TO-CURRENT CONVERTER . ................................................................... 6-24
A CURRENT SENSOR INTERFACE .................................................................................................... 6-24
OUTPUT BUFFERING, LOW POWER IN-AMPS ................................................................................ 6-25
A 4 TO 20 mA SINGLE-SUPPLY RECEIVER ....................................................................................... 6-26
A SINGLE-SUPPLY THERMOCOUPLE AMPLIFIER .......................................................................... 6-26
SPECIALTY PRODUCTS ...................................................................................................................... 6-26
Chapter vii—matching in-amp circuits to modern adcs . ......................................... 7-1
Calculating ADC Requirements . ............................................................................................................ 7-1
Matching ADI In-Amps with Some Popular ADCs . ................................................................................ 7-2
High Speed Data Acquisition . ................................................................................................................ 7-7
A High Speed In-Amp Circuit for Data Acquisition . ............................................................................... 7-8
APPENDIX A—INSTRUMENTATION AMPLIFIER SPECIFICATIONS ......................................... A-1
(A) Specifications (Conditions) ............................................................................................................. A-3
(B)Common-Mode Rejection .............................................................................................................. A-3
(C)AC Common-Mode Rejection ........................................................................................................ A-3
(D)Voltage Offset . ............................................................................................................................... A-3
(E) Input Bias and Offset Currents ....................................................................................................... A-4
(F)Operating Voltage Range ................................................................................................................. A-4
(G)Quiescent Supply Current .............................................................................................................. A-4
(H)Settling Time . ................................................................................................................................ A-5
(I) Gain .............................................................................................................................................. A-5
(J) Gain Range .................................................................................................................................... A-5
(K)Gain Error ..................................................................................................................................... A-5
(L)Nonlinearity ................................................................................................................................... A-6
(M)Gain vs. Temperature ...................................................................................................................... A-6
(N)Key Specifications for Single-Supply In-Amps ................................................................................. A-6
Input and Output Voltage Swing . .............................................................................................................. A-6
APPENDIX B—AMPLIFIERS SELECTION TABLE . ........................................................................ B-1
INDEX .................................................................................................................................................... C-1
DEVICE INDEX .................................................................................................................................... D-1
BIBLIOGRAPHY/FURTHER READING
Brokaw, Paul. “An IC Amplifier Users’ Guide to Decoupling, Grounding, and Making Things Go Right for a
Change.” Application Note AN-202, Rev. B. Analog Devices, Inc. 2000.
Jung, Walter. IC Op Amp Cookbook. 3rd ed. Prentice-Hall PTR. 1986. 1997. ISBN: 0-13-889601-1.
This can also be purchased on the Web at http://dogbert.abebooks.com.
Jung, Walter. Op Amp Applications Handbook. Elsevier/Newnes. 2006.
Jung, Walter. Op Amp Applications. Analog Devices. 2002. These seminar notes are an early version of the
Op Amp Applications Handbook. You can download this (Free) on the Web at: http://www.analog.com/library/
analogdialogue/archives/39-05/op_amp_applications_handbook.html.
Kester, Walt. The Data Conversion Handbook. Elsevier/Newnes. 2005. ISBN: 0-7506-7841-0.
Kester, Walt. Mixed-Signal and DSP Design Techniques. Elsevier/Newnes. 2003. ISBN: 0-7506-7611-6.
Kester, Walt. Practical Design Techniques for Sensor Signal Conditioning. Analog Devices, Inc. 1999. Section 10.
ISBN-0-916550-20-6. Available for download on the ADI website at www.analog.com.
Moghimi, Reza. “Bridge-Type Sensor Measurements Are Enhanced by Auto-Zeroed Instrumentation
Amplifiers with Digitally Programmable Gain and Offset.” Analog Dialogue. May 3, 2004. http://www.analog.
com/library/analogdialogue/archives/38-05/AD8555.html.
Nash, Eamon. “Errors and Error Budget Analysis in Instrumentation Amplifier Applications.” Application
Note AN-539. Analog Devices, Inc.
Nash, Eamon. “A Practical Review of Common-Mode and Instrumentation Amplifiers.” Sensors Magazine.
July 1998.
Sheingold, Dan, ed. Transducer Interface Handbook. Analog Devices, Inc. 1980. pp. 28-30.
Wurcer, Scott and Walter Jung. “Instrumentation Amplifiers Solve Unusual Design Problems.” Application
Note AN-245. Applications Reference Manual. Analog Devices, Inc.
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
We gratefully acknowledge the support and assistance of the following: Moshe Gerstenhaber, Scott
Wurcer, Stephen Lee, Bright Gao, Scott Pavlik, Henri Sino, Alasdair Alexander, Chau Tran, Andrew
Tang, Tom Botker, Jim Bundock, Sam Weinstein, Chuck Whiting, Matt Duff, Eamon Nash, Walt Kester,
Alain Guery, Chris Augusta, Claire Croke, Nicola O’Byrne, James Staley, Ben Doubts, Padraig Cooney,
Leslie Vaughan, Edie Kramer, and Lynne Hulme of Analog Devices. Also to David Anthony of X2Y
Technology and Steven Weir of Weir Design Engineering, for the detailed applications information on
applying X2Y products for RFI suppression.
And finally, a special thank you to Analog Devices’ Communications Services team, including John Galgay,
Alex Wong, Terry Gildred, Kirsten Dickerson, and Kelley Moretta.
All brand or product names mentioned are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective owners.
Purchase of licensed I2C components of Analog Devices or one of its sublicensed Associated Companies conveys a license for the purchaser under the Philips
I2C Patent Rights to use these components in an I2C system, provided that the system conforms to the I2C Standard Specification as defined by Philips.
vi
Chapter I
IN-AMP BASICS
Introduction
BRIDGE SUPPLY
VOLTAGE
Instrumentation amplifiers (in-amps) are sometimes
misunderstood. Not all amplifiers used in instrumentation applications are instrumentation amplifiers, and by
no means are all in-amps used only in instrumentation
applications. In-amps are used in many applications,
from motor control to data acquisition to automotive.
The intent of this guide is to explain the fundamentals
of what an instrumentation amplifier is, how it operates,
and how and where to use it. In addition, several different categories of instrumentation amplifiers are
addressed in this guide.
0.01�F
1
2
3
4
Figure 1-1 shows a bridge preamp circuit, a typical in-amp
application.When sensing a signal, the bridge resistor values
change, unbalancing the bridge and causing a change in
differential voltage across the bridge. The signal output
of the bridge is this differential voltage, which connects
directly to the in-amp’s inputs. In addition, a constant dc
voltage is also present on both lines. This dc voltage will
normally be equal or common mode on both input lines. In
its primary function, the in-amp will normally reject the
common-mode dc voltage, or any other voltage common
to both lines, while amplifying the differential signal voltage,
the difference in voltage between the two lines.
7
AD8221
VOUT
6
–
0.01�F
Unlike an op amp, for which closed-loop gain is determined by external resistors connected between its
inverting input and its output, an in-amp employs an
internal feedback resistor network that is isolated from its
signal input terminals.With the input signal applied across
the two differential inputs, gain is either preset internally
or is user set (via pins) by an internal or external gain
resistor, which is also isolated from the signal inputs.
0.33�F
8
+
RG
IN-AMPS vs. OP AMPS: WHAT ARE THE
DIFFERENCES?
An instrumentation amplifier is a closed-loop gain
block that has a differential input and an output that
is single-ended with respect to a reference terminal.
Most commonly, the impedances of the two input
terminals are balanced and have high values, typically
109 , or greater. The input bias currents should also
be low, typically 1 nA to 50 nA. As with op amps, output
impedance is very low, nominally only a few milliohms,
at low frequencies.
+VS
5
–VS
REF
0.33�F
Figure 1-1. AD8221 bridge circuit.
In contrast, if a standard op amp amplifier circuit were
used in this application, it would simply amplify both the
signal voltage and any dc, noise, or other common-mode
voltages. As a result, the signal would remain buried under
the dc offset and noise. Because of this, even the best
op amps are far less effective in extracting weak signals.
Figure 1-2 contrasts the differences between op amp and
in-amp input characteristics.
Signal Amplification and Common-Mode Rejection
An instrumentation amplifier is a device that amplifies
the difference between two input signal voltages while
rejecting any signals that are common to both inputs.The
in-amp, therefore, provides the very important function
of extracting small signals from transducers and other
signal sources.
Common-mode rejection (CMR), the property of
canceling out any signals that are common (the same
potential on both inputs), while amplifying any signals
that are differential (a potential difference between the
inputs), is the most important function an instrumentation amplifier provides. Both dc and ac common-mode
rejection are important in-amp specifications. Any errors
due to dc common-mode voltage (i.e., dc voltage present
at both inputs) will be reduced 80 dB to 120 dB by any
modern in-amp of decent quality.
However, inadequate ac CMR causes a large, timevarying error that often changes greatly with frequency
and, therefore, is difficult to remove at the IA’s output.
Fortunately, most modern monolithic IC in-amps provide
excellent ac and dc common-mode rejection.
1-1
Common-mode gain (ACM), the ratio of change in
output voltage to change in common-mode input voltage, is related to common-mode rejection. It is the net
gain (or attenuation) from input to output for voltages
common to both inputs. For example, an in-amp with
a common-mode gain of 1/1000 and a 10 V commonmode voltage at its inputs will exhibit a 10 mV output
change. The differential or normal mode gain (AD) is
the gain between input and output for voltages applied
differentially (or across) the two inputs. The commonmode rejection ratio (CMRR) is simply the ratio of
the differential gain, AD, to the common-mode gain.
Note that in an ideal in-amp, CMRR will increase in
proportion to gain.
Common-mode rejection is usually specified for full
range common-mode voltage (CMV) change at a given
frequency and a specified imbalance of source impedance
(e.g., 1 k source imbalance, at 60 Hz).
Mathematically, common-mode rejection can be represented as
where:
AD is the differential gain of the amplifier;
VCM is the common-mode voltage present at the
amplifier inputs;
VOUT is the output voltage present when a common-mode
input signal is applied to the amplifier.
The term CMR is a logarithmic expression of the
common-mode rejection ratio (CMRR).That is, CMR =
20 log10 CMRR.
To be effective, an in-amp needs to be able to amplify
microvolt-level signals while rejecting common-mode
voltage at its inputs. It is particularly important for the
in-amp to be able to reject common-mode signals over the
bandwidth of interest. This requires that instrumentation amplifiers have very high common-mode rejection
over the main frequency of interest and its harmonics.
IN-LINE CURRENT MEASUREMENT
I
THE VERY HIGH VALUE, CLOSELY MATCHED INPUT
RESISTANCES CHARACTERISTIC OF IN-AMPS
MAKE THEM IDEAL FOR MEASURING LOW
LEVEL VOLTAGES AND CURRENTS—WITHOUT
LOADING DOWN THE SIGNAL SOURCE.
REFERENCE
VOLTAGE
R1
R2
V 
CMRR = AD  CM 
 VOUT 
R
R–
V
R+
IN-AMP
R3
R4
OUTPUT
REFERENCE
R–
OUTPUT
R+
VOLTAGE
MEASUREMENT
FROM A BRIDGE
IN-AMP
REFERENCE
THE INPUT RESISTANCE OF A TYPICAL IN-AMP
IS VERY HIGH AND IS EQUAL ON BOTH INPUTS.
CREATES A NEGLIGIBLE ERROR VOLTAGE.
R– = R+ = 109
TO 10 12
IN-AMP INPUT CHARACTERISTICS
R2
RIN = R1 ( 1k TO 1M )
GAIN = R2/R1
RIN = R+ (106 TO 10 12 )
GAIN = 1 + (R2/R1)
R1
R–
R–
TYPICAL
R+ OP AMP
OUTPUT
R+
TYPICAL
OP AMP
OUTPUT
A MODEL SHOWING THE INPUT
RESISTANCE OF A TYPICAL OP AMP
IN THE OPEN-LOOP CONDITION
A MODEL SHOWING THE INPUT RESISTANCE OF A
TYPICAL OP AMP OPERATING AS AN INVERTING
AMPLIFIER—AS SEEN BY THE INPUT SOURCE
(R–) = (R+) = 106
OP AMP INPUT CHARACTERISTICS
Figure 1-2. Op amp vs. in-amp input characteristics.
1-2
TO 10 15
For techniques on reducing errors due to out-of-band
signals that may appear as a dc output offset, please refer
to the RFI section of this guide.
At unity gain, typical dc values of CMR are 70 dB to more
than 100 dB, with CMR usually improving at higher gains.
While it is true that operational amplifiers connected as
subtractors also provide common-mode rejection, the
user must provide closely matched external resistors
(to provide adequate CMRR). On the other hand,
monolithic in-amps, with their pretrimmed resistor
networks, are far easier to apply.
Common-Mode Rejection: Op Amp vs. In-Amp
Op amps, in-amps, and difference amps all provide
common-mode rejection. However, in-amps and diff
amps are designed to reject common-mode signals so
that they do not appear at the amplifier’s output. In
contrast, an op amp operated in the typical inverting
or noninverting amplifier configuration will process
common-mode signals, passing them through to the
output, but will not normally reject them.
Figure 1-3a shows an op amp connected to an input
source that is riding on a common-mode voltage. Because
of feedback applied externally between the output and
the summing junction, the voltage on the “–” input is
forced to be the same as that on the “+” input voltage.
Therefore, the op amp ideally will have zero volts across
its input terminals. As a result, the voltage at the op amp
output must equal VCM, for zero volts differential input.
Even though the op amp has common-mode rejection, the
common-mode voltage is transferred to the output along
with the signal. In practice, the signal is amplified by the
op amp’s closed-loop gain, while the common-mode
voltage receives only unity gain. This difference in gain
does provide some reduction in common-mode voltage
as a percentage of signal voltage. However, the commonmode voltage still appears at the output, and its presence
reduces the amplifier’s available output swing. For many
reasons, any common-mode signal (dc or ac) appearing
at the op amp’s output is highly undesirable.
VOUT = (VIN  GAIN) VCM
GAIN = R2/R1
CM GAIN = 1
V– = VCM
VCM
R1
VCM
VIN
R2
ZERO V
VOUT
V+ = VCM
Figure 1-3a. In a typical inverting or noninverting amplifier circuit using an op amp,
both the signal voltage and the common-mode voltage appear at the amplifier output.
1-3
Figure 1-3b shows a 3-op amp in-amp operating under
the same conditions. Note that, just like the op amp
circuit, the input buffer amplifiers of the in-amp pass the
common-mode signal through at unity gain. In contrast,
the signal is amplified by both buffers. The output signals
from the two buffers connect to the subtractor section of
the IA. Here the differential signal is amplified (typically
at low gain or unity) while the common-mode voltage is
attenuated (typically by 10,000:1 or more). Contrasting
the two circuits, both provide signal amplification (and
buffering), but because of its subtractor section, the inamp rejects the common-mode voltage.
Figure 1-3c is an in-amp bridge circuit. The in-amp
effectively rejects the dc common-mode voltage
appearing at the two bridge outputs while amplifying
the very weak bridge signal voltage. In addition, many
modern in-amps provide a common-mode rejection approaching 80 dB, which allows powering of the bridge
from an inexpensive, nonregulated dc power supply. In
contrast, a self constructed in-amp, using op amps and
0.1% resistors, typically only achieves 48 dB CMR, thus
requiring a regulated dc supply for bridge power.
BUFFER
VOUT = VIN (GAIN)
VCM
VCM
VCM
VIN
SUBTRACTOR
RG
VOUT
VIN TIMES
GAIN
VCM = 0
VCM
BUFFER
VCM
3-OP AMP
IN-AMP
Figure 1-3b. As with the op amp circuit above, the input buffers of an in-amp circuit
amplify the signal voltage while the common-mode voltage receives unity gain. However, the common-mode voltage is then rejected by the in-amp’s subtractor section.
VSUPPLY
VCM
BRIDGE
SENSOR
VIN
VCM
IN-AMP
VOUT
INTERNAL OR EXTERNAL
GAIN RESISTOR
Figure 1-3c. An in-amp used in a bridge circuit. Here the dc common-mode
voltage can easily be a large percentage of the supply voltage.
1-4
Figure 1-3d shows a difference (subtractor) amplifier
being used to monitor the voltage of an individual cell
that is part of a battery bank. Here the common-mode
dc voltage can easily be much higher than the amplifier’s
supply voltage. Some monolithic difference amplifiers,
such as the AD629, can operate with common-mode
voltages as high as 270 V.
Difference Amplifiers
Figure 1-4 is a block diagram of a difference amplifier.
This type of IC is a special-purpose in-amp that normally
consists of a subtractor amplifier followed by an output
buffer, which may also be a gain stage. The four resistors
used in the subtractor are normally internal to the IC,
and, therefore, are closely matched for high CMR.
Many difference amplifiers are designed to be used in
applications where the common-mode and signal voltages
may easily exceed the supply voltage. These diff amps
typically use very high value input resistors to attenuate
both signal and common-mode input voltages.
WHERE are in-amps and Difference
amps used?
Data Acquisition
In-amps find their primary use amplifying signals from
low level output transducers in noisy environments. The
amplification of pressure or temperature transducer
signals is a common in-amp application. Common bridge
applications include strain and weight measurement using
load cells and temperature measurement using resistive
temperature detectors, or RTDs.
DIFFERENCE AMPLIFIER
380k
VCM
380k
VIN
VOUT
380k
VCM
380k
Figure 1-3d. A difference amp is especially useful in applications such as battery
cell measurement, where the dc (or ac) common-mode voltage may be greater
than the supply voltage.
+15V
0.1�F
C1
0.1�F
DIFFERENTIAL
INPUT
SIGNAL
4
10k�
8
100k�
1
10k�
A1
100k�
2
+VS
A2
VREF
RG
3
5
6
0.1�F
RG
RF
C2
–15V
Figure 1-4. A difference amplifier IC.
1-5
VOUT
TO ADC
VOUT
–IN
10k�
–VS
+IN
+IN
VCM
7
AD628
–IN
VIN
CFILTER
Medical Instrumentation
High Speed Signal Conditioning
In-amps are widely used in medical equipment such as
EKG and EEG monitors, blood pressure monitors, and
defibrillators.
Because the speed and accuracy of modern video data
acquisition systems have improved, there is now a
growing need for high bandwidth instrumentation amplifiers, particularly in the field of CCD imaging equipment
where offset correction and input buffering are required.
Double-correlated sampling techniques are often used
in this area for offset correction of the CCD image. Two
sample-and-hold amplifiers monitor the pixel and reference
levels, and a dc-corrected output is provided by feeding
their signals into an instrumentation amplifier.
Monitor and Control Electronics
Diff amps may be used to monitor voltage or current in
a system and then trigger alarm systems when nominal
operating levels are exceeded. Because of their ability to
reject high common-mode voltages, diff amps are often
used in these applications.
Software-Programmable Applications
An in-amp may be used with a software-programmable
resistor chip to allow software control of hardware
systems.
Audio Applications
Because of their high common-mode rejection,
instrumentation amplifiers are sometimes used for audio
applications (as microphone preamps, for example), to
extract a weak signal from a noisy environment, and to
minimize offsets and noise due to ground loops. Refer
to Table 6-4 (page 6-26), Specialty Products Available
from Analog Devices.
./)3%
Video Applications
High speed in-amps may be used in many video and cable
RF systems to amplify or process high frequency signals.
Power Control Applications
In-amps can also be used for motor monitoring (to
monitor and control motor speed, torque, etc.) by measuring the voltages, currents, and phase relationships
of a 3-phase ac-phase motor. Diff amps are used in
applications where the input signal exceeds the
supply voltages.
IN-AMPS: AN EXTERNAL VIEW
Figure 1-5 provides a functional block diagram of an
instrumentation amplifier.
'!).
3%,%#4
3)'.!,
3/52#%
$#
35 0/
00 7%
,)% 2
3
./.
).6%24).'
).054
2$)&&
2#-
).3425-%.4!4)/.
!-0,)&)%2
6$)&&
2$)&&
./)3%
).6%24).'
).054
6#- #/--/.-/$%
6/,4!'%
6/54
,/!$
2%&%2%.#%
./)3%
'!).3%,%#4)/.)3!##/-0,)3(%$%)4(%2
"949).'0).34/'%4(%2/2"94(%53%/&
%84%2.!,'!).3%44).'2%3)34/23
3500,9'2/5.$
,/!$2%452.
Figure 1-5. Differential vs. common-mode input signals.
1-6
Since an ideal instrumentation amplifier detects only the
difference in voltage between its inputs, any commonmode signals (equal potentials for both inputs), such as
noise or voltage drops in ground lines, are rejected at the
input stage without being amplified.
Of course, power must be supplied to the in-amp. As
with op amps, the power would normally be provided
by a dual-supply voltage that operates the in-amp over
a specified range. Alternatively, an in-amp specified for
single-supply (rail-to-rail) operation may be used.
Either internal or external resistors may be used to set
the gain. Internal resistors are the most accurate and
provide the lowest gain drift over temperature.
An instrumentation amplifier may be assembled using one
or more operational amplifiers, or it may be of monolithic
construction. Both technologies have their advantages
and limitations.
One common approach is to use a single external resistor,
working with two internal resistors, to set the gain. The
user can calculate the required value of resistance for a
given gain, using the gain equation listed in the in-amp’s
spec sheet. This permits gain to be set anywhere within a
very large range. However, the external resistor can seldom
be exactly the correct value for the desired gain, and it
will always be at a slightly different temperature than the
IC’s internal resistors. These practical limitations always
contribute additional gain error and gain drift.
Sometimes two external resistors are employed. In general,
a 2-resistor solution will have lower drift than a single
resistor as the ratio of the two resistors sets the gain, and
these resistors can be within a single IC array for close
matching and very similar temperature coefficients (TC).
Conversely, a single external resistor will always be a TC
mismatch for an on-chip resistor.
The output of an instrumentation amplifier often has
its own reference terminal, which, among other uses,
allows the in-amp to drive a load that may be at a
distant location.
Figure 1-5 shows the input and output commons being
returned to the same potential, in this case to power
supply ground. This star ground connection is a very effective means of minimizing ground loops in the circuit;
however, some residual common-mode ground currents
will still remain. These currents flowing through RCM
will develop a common-mode voltage error, VCM. The
in-amp, by virtue of its high common-mode rejection,
will amplify the differential signal while rejecting VCM
and any common-mode noise.
In general, discrete (op amp) in-amps offer design flexibility at low cost and can sometimes provide performance
unattainable with monolithic designs, such as very high
bandwidth. In contrast, monolithic designs provide
complete in-amp functionality and are fully specified
and usually factory trimmed, often to higher dc precision
than discrete designs. Monolithic in-amps are also much
smaller, lower in cost, and easier to apply.
WHAT OTHER PROPERTIES DEFINE A HIGH
QUALITY IN-AMP?
Possessing a high common-mode rejection ratio, an
instrumentation amplifier requires the properties
described below.
High AC (and DC) Common-Mode Rejection
At a minimum, an in-amp’s CMR should be high over
the range of input frequencies that need to be rejected.
This includes high CMR at power line frequencies and
at the second harmonic of the power line frequency.
Low Offset Voltage and Offset Voltage Drift
As with an operational amplifier, an in-amp must have
low offset voltage. Since an instrumentation amplifier
consists of two independent sections, an input stage and
an output amplifier, total output offset will equal the sum
of the gain times the input offset plus the offset of the
output amplifier (within the in-amp). Typical values for
input and output offset drift are 1 V/C and 10 V/C,
respectively. Although the initial offset voltage may be
nulled with external trimming, offset voltage drift cannot
be adjusted out. As with initial offset, offset drift has two
components, with the input and output section of the
in-amp each contributing its portion of error to the total.
As gain is increased, the offset drift of the input stage
becomes the dominant source of offset error.
1-7
A Matched, High Input Impedance
Low Noise
The impedances of the inverting and noninverting input
terminals of an in-amp must be high and closely matched
to one another. High input impedance is necessary to
avoid loading down the input signal source, which could
also lower the input signal voltage.
Because it must be able to handle very low level input
voltages, an in-amp must not add its own noise to that of
the signal. A minimum input noise level of 10 nV/√Hz @
1 kHz (gain > 100) referred to input (RTI) is desirable.
Micropower in-amps are optimized for the lowest possible
input stage current and, therefore, typically have higher
noise levels than their higher current cousins.
Values of input impedance from 109  to 1012  are
typical. Difference amplifiers, such as the AD629, have
lower input impedances, but can be very effective in high
common-mode voltage applications.
Low Input Bias and Offset Current Errors
Again, as with an op amp, an instrumentation amplifier has bias currents that flow into, or out of, its input
terminals; bipolar in-amps have base currents and FET
amplifiers have gate leakage currents. This bias current
flowing through an imbalance in the signal source
resistance will create an offset error. Note that if the
input source resistance becomes infinite, as with ac
(capacitive) input coupling, without a resistive return
to power supply ground, the input common-mode
voltage will climb until the amplifier saturates. A high
value resistor connected between each input and ground
is normally used to prevent this problem. Typically, the
input bias current multiplied by the resistor’s value in
ohms should be less than 10 mV (see Chapter V). Input
offset current errors are defined as the mismatch between
the bias currents flowing into the two inputs. Typical
values of input bias current for a bipolar in-amp range
from 1 nA to 50 nA; for a FET input device, values of
1 pA to 50 pA are typical at room temperature.
Low Nonlinearity
Input offset and scale factor errors can be corrected by
external trimming, but nonlinearity is an inherent performance limitation of the device and cannot be removed by
external adjustment. Low nonlinearity must be designed
in by the manufacturer. Nonlinearity is normally specified
as a percentage of full scale, whereas the manufacturer
measures the in-amp’s error at the plus and minus fullscale voltage and at zero. A nonlinearity error of 0.01%
is typical for a high quality in-amp; some devices have
levels as low as 0.0001%.
Simple Gain Selection
Gain selection should be easy. The use of a single
external gain resistor is common, but an external resistor will affect the circuit’s accuracy and gain drift with
temperature. In-amps, such as the AD621, provide a
choice of internally preset gains that are pin-selectable,
with very low gain TC.
Adequate Bandwidth
An instrumentation amplifier must provide bandwidth
sufficient for the particular application. Since typical unitygain, small-signal bandwidths fall between 500 kHz and
4 MHz, performance at low gains is easily achieved, but at
higher gains bandwidth becomes much more of an issue.
Micropower in-amps typically have lower bandwidth than
comparable standard in-amps, as micropower input stages
are operated at much lower current levels.
1-8
Differential to Single-Ended Conversion
Differential to single-ended conversion is, of course, an
integral part of an in-amp’s function: A differential input
voltage is amplified and a buffered, single-ended output
voltage is provided.There are many in-amp applications
that require amplifying a differential voltage that is riding
on top of a much larger common-mode voltage. This
common-mode voltage may be noise, or ADC offset,
or both. The use of an op amp rather than an in-amp
would simply amplify both the common mode and the
signal by equal amounts. The great benefit provided by
an in-amp is that it selectively amplifies the (differential)
signal while rejecting the common-mode signal.
Rail-to-Rail Input and Output Swing
Modern in-amps often need to operate on single-supply
voltages of 5 V or less. In many of these applications, a
rail-to-rail input ADC is often used. So-called rail-to-rail
operation means that an amplifier’s maximum input or
output swing is essentially equal to the power supply
voltage. In fact, the input swing can sometimes exceed
the supply voltage slightly, while the output swing is often
within 100 mV of the supply voltage or ground. Careful
attention to the data sheet specifications is advised.
Power vs. Bandwidth, Slew Rate, and Noise
As a general rule, the higher the operating current of
the in-amp’s input section, the greater the bandwidth
and slew rate and the lower the noise. But higher operating
current means higher power dissipation and heat. Batteryoperated equipment needs to use low power devices,
and densely packed printed circuit boards must be
able to dissipate the collective heat of all their active
components. Device heating also increases offset drift
and other temperature-related errors. IC designers
often must trade off some specifications to keep power
dissipation and drift to acceptable levels.
1-9
Chapter II
INSIDE AN INSTRUMENTATION AMPLIFIER
A Simple Op Amp Subtractor Provides an
In-Amp Function
Furthermore, this circuit requires a very close ratio match
between resistor pairs R1/R2 and R3/R4; otherwise, the
gain from each input would be different­—directly affecting common-mode rejection. For example, at a gain of
1, with all resistors of equal value, a 0.1% mismatch in
just one of the resistors will degrade the CMR to a level
of 66 dB (1 part in 2000). Similarly, a source resistance
imbalance of 100  will degrade CMR by 6 dB.
The simplest (but still very useful) method of implementing a differential gain block is shown in Figure 2-1.
6).
).6%24).'
).054
2
K6
2
6/546). n6). nnn
2
&/22222
2
K6
6).
./.).6%24).'
).054
2
K6
!
2
K6
In spite of these problems, this type of bare bones in-amp
circuit, often called a difference amplifier or subtractor,
is useful as a building block within higher performance
in-amps. It is also very practical as a standalone functional circuit in video and other high speed uses, or in
low frequency, high common-mode voltage (CMV)
applications, where the input resistors divide down the
input voltage as well as provide input protection for the
amplifier. Some monolithic difference amplifiers such
as Analog Devices’ AD629 employ a variation of the
simple subtractor in their design. This allows the IC to
handle common-mode input voltages higher than its
own supply voltage. For example, when powered from
a 15 V supply, the AD629 can amplify signals with
common-mode voltages as high as 270 V.
6/54
!/0
2%&%2%.#%
Figure 2-1. A 1-op amp in-amp difference
amplifier circuit functional block diagram.
If R1 = R3 and R2 = R4, then
VOUT = ( VIN2 − VIN1 ) ( R2 R1)
Although this circuit provides an in-amp function, amplifying differential signals while rejecting those that are
common mode, it also has some limitations. First, the
impedances of the inverting and noninverting inputs are
relatively low and unequal. In this example, the input impedance to V IN1 equals 100 k, while the impedance of
V IN2 is twice that, at 200 k. Therefore, when voltage is
applied to one input while grounding the other, different
currents will flow depending on which input receives
the applied voltage. (This unbalance in the sources’
resistances will degrade the circuit’s CMRR.)
6).
).6%24).'
).054
Improving the Simple Subtractor with
Input Buffering
An obvious way to significantly improve performance is
to add high input impedance buffer amplifiers ahead of
the simple subtractor circuit, as shown in the 3-op amp
instrumentation amplifier circuit of Figure 2-2.
!!/0!$
!/0
!
K6
K6
2
2
2
6/546).n6). ˆˆ
2
&/22222
2
2
2%&%2%.#%
K6
K6
6).
./.).6%24).'
).054
6/54
!
!
).054
3%#4)/.
/54054
3%#4)/.
Figure 2-2. A subtractor circuit with input buffering.
2-1
This circuit provides matched, high impedance inputs
so that the impedances of the input sources will have a
minimal effect on the circuit’s common-mode rejection.
The use of a dual op amp for the 2-input buffer amplifiers is preferred because they will better track each other
over temperature and save board space. Although the
resistance values are different, this circuit has the same
transfer function as the circuit of Figure 2-1.
Figure 2-3 shows further improvement: Now the input
buffers are operating with gain, which provides a circuit
with more flexibility. If the value of R5 = R8 and R6 =
R7 and, as before, R1 = R3 and R2 = R4, then
VOUT = (VIN2 – VIN1) (1 + R5/R6) (R2/R1)
While the circuit of Figure 2-3 does increase the gain (of
A1 and A2) equally for differential signals, it also increases
the gain for common-mode signals.
The 3-Op Amp In-Amp
The circuit of Figure 2-4 provides further refinement
and has become the most popular configuration for
instrumentation amplifier design. The classic 3-op amp
in-amp circuit is a clever modification of the buffered
subtractor circuit of Figure 2-3. As with the previous
circuit, op amps A1 and A2 of Figure 2-4 buffer the
input voltage. However, in this configuration, a single
gain resistor, RG, is connected between the summing
junctions of the two input buffers, replacing R6 and
R7. The full differential input voltage will now appear
across RG (because the voltage at the summing junction
of each amplifier is equal to the voltage applied to its
positive input). Since the amplified input voltage (at the
outputs of A1 and A2) appears differentially across the
three resistors, R5, RG, and R6, the differential gain may
be varied by just changing RG.
!!/0!$
!/0
6).
).6%24).'
).054
!
2
2
2
6/546).n6). ˆˆˆˆ
2 2
2
K
&/222222222
2
K
2
!
6).
./.).6%24).'
).054
K
K
2
2
6/54
!
2
2%&%2%.#%
2
K
).054
3%#4)/.
K
/54054
3%#4)/.
Figure 2-3. A buffered subtractor circuit with buffer amplifiers operating with gain.
6).
).6%24).'
).054
!!/0!$
!/0
!
2
2 2
6/546).n6).ˆˆˆˆ
2' 2
K6
K6
2
2
2'
K6
6/54
!
2
2
2%&%2%.#%
K6
K6
&/2222222
2
!
6).
./.).6%24).'
).054
3%.3%
).054
3%#4)/.
/54054
3%#4)/.
Figure 2-4. The classic 3-op amp in-amp circuit.
2-2
3-Op Amp In-Amp Design Considerations
There is another advantage of this connection: Once the
subtractor circuit has been set up with its ratio-matched
resistors, no further resistor matching is required when
changing gains. If the value of R5 = R6, R1 = R3, and
R2 = R4, then
Two alternatives are available for constructing 3-op amp
instrumentation amplifiers: using FET or bipolar input
operational amplifiers. FET input op amps have very low
bias currents and are generally well-suited for use with
very high (>106 ) source impedances. FET amplifiers
usually have lower CMR, higher offset voltage, and higher
offset drift than bipolar amplifiers.They also may provide
a higher slew rate for a given amount of power.
VOUT = (VIN2 – VIN1) (1 + 2R5/RG)(R2/R1)
Since the voltage across RG equals VIN, the current
through RG will equal (VIN/RG). Amplifiers A1 and A2,
therefore, will operate with gain and amplify the input
signal. Note, however, that if a common-mode voltage
is applied to the amplifier inputs, the voltages on each
side of RG will be equal, and no current will flow through
this resistor. Since no current flows through RG (nor,
therefore, through R5 and R6), amplifiers A1 and A2
will operate as unity-gain followers.Therefore, commonmode signals will be passed through the input buffers at
unity gain, but differential voltages will be amplified by
the factor (1 + (2 RF/RG)).
The sense and reference terminals (Figure 2-4) permit
the user to change A3’s feedback and ground connections. The sense pin may be externally driven for servo
applications and others for which the gain of A3 needs
to be varied. Likewise, the reference terminal allows an
external offset voltage to be applied to A3. For normal
operation, the sense and output terminals are tied
together, as are reference and ground.
Amplifiers with bipolar input stages tend to achieve both
higher CMR and lower input offset voltage drift than FET
input amplifiers. Superbeta bipolar input stages combine
many of the benefits of FET and bipolar processes, with
even lower IB drift than FET devices.
In theory, this means that the user may take as much
gain in the front end as desired (as determined by RG)
without increasing the common-mode gain and error.
That is, the differential signal will be increased by
gain, but the common-mode error will not, so the ratio
(Gain (VDIFF)/(VERROR CM)) will increase. Thus, CMRR
will theoretically increase in direct proportion to gain­—a
very useful property.
A common (but frequently overlooked) issue for the
unwary designer using a 3-op amp in-amp design is the
reduction of common-mode voltage range that occurs
when the in-amp is operating at high gain. Figure 2-5
is a schematic of a 3-op amp in-amp operating at a gain
of 1000.
Finally, because of the symmetry of this configuration,
common-mode errors in the input amplifiers, if they track,
tend to be canceled out by the output stage subtractor.
This includes such errors as common-mode rejection
vs. frequency. These features explain the popularity of
this configuration.
In this example, the input amplifiers, A1 and A2, are
operating at a gain of 1000, while the output amplifier
is providing unity gain. This means that the voltage at
the output of each input amplifier will equal one-half
+5V + CMV*
3
A1
1
2
50k
2
INVERTING
INPUT
SIGNAL VOLTAGE
10mV p-p
NONINVERTING
INPUT
COMMON-MODE
ERROR VOLTAGE
10k
10k
6
VOUT
3
*
50k
6
A2
5
A3
100
7
10k
10k
–5V + CMV*
Figure 2-5. A 3-op amp in-amp showing reduced CMV range.
2-3
the peak-to-peak input voltage  1000, plus any
common-mode voltage that is present on the inputs
(the common-mode voltage will pass through at unity
gain regardless of the differential gain). Therefore, if
a 10 mV differential signal is applied to the amplifier
inputs, amplifier A1’s output will equal +5 V, plus the
common-mode voltage, and A2’s output will be –5 V,
plus the common-mode voltage. If the amplifiers are
operating from 15 V supplies, they will usually have
7 V or so of headroom left, thus permitting an 8 V
common-mode voltage—but not the full 12 V of CMV,
which, typically, would be available at unity gain (for a
10 mV input). Higher gains or lower supply voltages will
further reduce the common-mode voltage range.
The Basic 2-Op Amp Instrumentation Amplifier
Figure 2-6 is a schematic of a typical 2-op amp in-amp
circuit. It has the obvious advantage of requiring only two,
rather than three, operational amplifiers and providing
savings in cost and power consumption. However, the
nonsymmetrical topology of the 2-op amp in-amp circuit
can lead to several disadvantages, most notably lower ac
CMRR compared to the 3-op amp design, limiting the
circuit’s usefulness.
The transfer function of this circuit is
VOUT = (VIN2 – VIN1) (1 + R4/R3)
for R1 = R4 and R2 = R3
Input resistance is high and balanced, thus permitting the
signal source to have an unbalanced output impedance.
The circuit’s input bias currents are set by the input
current requirements of the noninverting input of the
two op amps, which typically are very low.
Disadvantages of this circuit include the inability to operate at unity gain, a decreased common-mode voltage range
as circuit gain is lowered, and poor ac common-mode
rejection. The poor CMR is due to the unequal phase
shift occurring in the two inputs, VIN1 and VIN2. That is,
the signal must travel through amplifier A1 before it is
subtracted from VIN2 by amplifier A2. Thus, the voltage
at the output of A1 is slightly delayed or phase-shifted
with respect to VIN1.
Minimum circuit gains of 5 are commonly used with
the 2-op amp in-amp circuit because this permits an adequate dc common-mode input range, as well as sufficient
bandwidth for most applications. The use of rail-to-rail
(single-supply) amplifiers will provide a common-mode
voltage range that extends down to –VS (or ground in
single-supply operation), plus true rail-to-rail output voltage range (i.e., an output swing from +VS to –VS).
Table 2-1 shows amplifier gain vs. circuit gain for the
circuit of Figure 2-6 and gives practical 1% resistor
values for several common circuit gains.
Table 2-1. Operating Gains of Amplifiers A1
and A2 and Practical 1% Resistor Values for the
Circuit of Figure 2-6.
Circuit
Gain
1.10
1.33
1.50
2.00
10.1
101.0
1001
Gain
of A1
11.00
4.01
3.00
2.00
1.11
1.01
1.001
Gain
of A2
R2, R3
1.10
499 k
1.33
150 k
1.50
100 k
2.00
49.9 k
10.10
5.49 k
101.0
499 
1001
49.9 
RG (OPTIONAL)
A1, A2: OP2177, AD8698
R1
R2
49.9k
VIN2
RP*
49.9k
R4
49.9k
0.1 F
2
VIN1
R3
8
A1
5
1
A2
3
7
4
6
0.1 F
VOUT
RP*
–VS
49.9k
VOUT = V IN2 – V IN1
* OPTIONAL INPUT PROTECTION
RESISTOR FOR GAINS GREATER
THAN 100 OR INPUT VOLTAGES
EXCEEDING THE SUPPLY VOLTAGE
R4 + ––––
2R4
1 + –––
R3
RG
FOR R1 = R4, R2 = R3
Figure 2-6. A 2-op amp in-amp circuit.
2-4
R1, R4
49.9 k
49.9 k
49.9 k
49.9 k
49.9 k
49.9 k
49.9 k
2-Op Amp In-Amps­—Common-Mode Design
Considerations for Single-Supply Operation
Figure 2-8 is a schematic of a 2-op amp in-amp operating
from a single 5 V power supply. The reference input is
tied to VS /2, which in this case is 2.5 V. The output
voltage should ideally be 2.5 V for a differential input
voltage of 0 V and for any common-mode voltage within
the power supply voltage range (0 V to 5 V).
When the 2-op amp in-amp circuit of Figure 2-7 is
examined from the reference input, it is apparent that it
is simply a cascade of two inverters.
Assuming that the voltage at both of the signal inputs,
VIN1 and VIN2, is 0, the output of A1 will equal
As the common-mode voltage is increased from 2.5 V
toward 5 V, the output voltage of A1 (VO1) will equal
VO1 = –VREF (R2/R1)
VO1 = VCM + ((VCM – VREF) (R2/R1))
A positive voltage applied to V REF will tend to drive
the output voltage of A1 negative, which is clearly not
possible if the amplifier is operating from a single power
supply voltage (+VS and 0 V).
In this case, VREF = 2.5 V and R2/R1 = 1/4. The output
voltage of A1 will reach 5 V when VCM = 4.5 V. Further
increases in common-mode voltage obviously cannot be
rejected. In practice, the input voltage range limitations
of amplifiers A1 and A2 may limit the in-amp’s commonmode voltage range to less than 4.5 V.
The gain from the output of amplifier A1 to the circuit’s
output, VOUT, at A2, is equal to
VOUT = –VO1 (R4/R3)
Similarly, as the common-mode voltage is reduced from
2.5 V toward 0 V, the output voltage of A1 will hit zero
for a VCM of 0.5 V. Clearly, the output of A1 cannot go
more negative than the negative supply line (assuming
no charge pump), which, for a single-supply connection,
equals 0 V. This negative or zero-in common-mode
range limitation can be overcome by proper design of the
in-amp’s internal level shifting, as in the AD627 monolithic 2-op amp instrumentation amplifier. However,
even with good design, some positive common-mode
voltage range will be traded off to achieve operation at
zero common-mode voltage.
The gain from VREF to VOUT is the product of these two
gains and equals
VOUT = (–VREF (R2/R1))(–R4/R3)
In this case, R1 = R4 and R2 = R3. Therefore, the
reference gain is +1, as expected. Note that this is the
result of two inversions, in contrast to the noninverting
signal path of the reference input in a typical 3-op amp
in-amp circuit.
Just as with the 3-op amp in-amp, the common-mode
voltage range of the 2-op amp in-amp can be limited
by single-supply operation and by the choice of
reference voltage.
VREF
R1
R2
R3
R4
4k�
1k�
1k�
4k�
A1
VO1
VIN1
A2
VOUT
VIN2
Figure 2-7. The 2-op amp in-amp architecture.
2.5V � –0.25 = 0.625V
+5V
+2.5V
AD580,
AD584
R1
R2
R3
R4
4k�
1k�
1k�
4k�
0V
–0.625V
VO1 0V
A1
VIN1
VIN2
0V
GAIN = 0.25
GAIN = –4
A2
VOUT
0V
–0.625V � –4 = +2.5
0V
Figure 2-8. Output swing limitations of 2-op amp in-amp using a 2.5 V reference.
2-5
Assume that a sinusoidal common-mode voltage, VCM,
at a frequency, FCM, is applied (common mode) to inputs
V IN1 and V IN2 (Figure 2-8). Ideally, the amplitude of
the resulting ac output voltage (the common-mode
error) should be 0 V, independent of frequency, FCM,
at least over the range of normal ac power line (mains)
frequencies: 50 Hz to 400 Hz. Power lines tend to be
the source of much common-mode interference.
If the ac common-mode error is zero, amplifier A2
and gain network R3, R4 must see zero instantaneous
difference between the common-mode voltage, applied
directly to VIN2, and the version of the common-mode
voltage that is amplified by A1 and its associated gain
network R1, R2. Any dc common-mode error (assuming
negligible error from the amplifier’s own CMRR) can
be nulled by trimming the ratios of R1, R2, R3, and R4
to achieve the balance
120
110
100
90
70
G = 100
60
50
G=5
40
30
20
10
0
1
10
100
VE G
f
(100%) = CM (100%)
VCM
fTI
where VE is the common-mode error voltage at VOUT,
and G is the differential gain—in this case, 5.
10k
100k
Figure 2-9. CMR vs. frequency of AD627
in-amp circuit.
For example, if A1 has a closed-loop bandwidth of
100 kHz (a typical value for a micropower op amp),
when operating at the gain set by R1 and R2, and the
common-mode frequency is 100 Hz, then
% CM Error =
However, any phase shift (delay) introduced by amplifier
A1 will cause the phase of VO1 to slightly lag behind
the phase of the directly applied common-mode
voltage of VIN2. This difference in phase will result in
an instantaneous (vector) difference in VO1 and VIN2,
even if the amplitudes of both voltages are at their
ideal levels. This will cause a frequency-dependent
common-mode error voltage at the circuit’s output,
VOUT. Further, this ac common-mode error will increase
linearly with common-mode frequency because the phase
shift through A1 (assuming a single-pole roll-off) will
increase directly with frequency. In fact, for frequencies
less than 1/10th the closed-loop bandwidth (fT1) of A1,
the common-mode error (referred to the input of the
in-amp) can be approximated by
1k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
R1  R4 and R2  R3
% CM Error =
G = 1000
80
CMR (dB)
Another, and perhaps more serious, limitation of the
standard 2-amplifier instrumentation amplifier circuit
compared to 3-amplifier designs, is the intrinsic difficulty
of achieving high ac common-mode rejection. This
limitation stems from the inherent imbalance in the
common-mode signal path of the 2-amplifier circuit.
100 Hz
(100%) = 0.1%
100 kHz
A common-mode error of 0.1% is equivalent to 60 dB
of common-mode rejection. So, in this example, even if
this circuit were trimmed to achieve 100 dB CMR at dc,
this would be valid only for frequencies less than 1 Hz. At
100 Hz, the CMR could never be better than 60 dB.
The AD627 monolithic in-amp embodies an advanced
version of the 2-op amp instrumentation amplifier
circuit that overcomes these ac common-mode rejection
limitations. As illustrated in Figure 2-9, the AD627
maintains over 80 dB of CMR out to 8 kHz (gain of
1000), even though the bandwidth of amplifiers A1
and A2 is only 150 kHz.
The four resistors used in the subtractor are normally
internal to the IC and are usually of very high resistance.
High common-mode voltage difference amps (diff amps)
typically use input resistors selected to provide voltage
attenuation. Therefore, both the differential signal
voltage and the common-mode voltage are attenuated,
the common mode is rejected, and then the signal
voltage is amplified.
2-6
Chapter III
MONOLITHIC INSTRUMENTATION AMPLIFIERS
Advantages Over Op Amp In-Amps
Monolithic IC instrumentation amplifiers were developed to satisfy the demand for in-amps that would be
easier to apply. These circuits incorporate variations in
the 3-op amp and 2-op amp in-amp circuits previously
described, while providing laser-trimmed resistors
and other benefits of monolithic IC technology. Since
both active and passive components are now within
the same die, they can be closely matched—this
will ensure that the device provides a high CMR. In
addition, these components will stay matched over
temperature, ensuring excellent performance over a
wide temperature range. IC technologies such as laser
wafer trimming allow monolithic integrated circuits
to be tuned up to very high accuracy and provide low
cost, high volume manufacturing. An additional advantage of monolithic devices is that they are available
in very small, very low cost SOIC, MSOP, or LFCSP
(chip scale) packages designed for use in high volume
production. Table 3-1 provides a quick performance
summary of Analog Devices in-amps.
Which to Use—an In-Amp or a Diff Amp?
Although instrumentation amplifiers and difference
amplifiers share many properties, the first step in the
design process should be which type of amplifier
to use.
A difference amplifier is basically an op amp subtractor,
typically using high value input resistors. The resistors
provide protection by limiting the amplifier’s input
current. They also reduce the input common-mode
and differential voltage to a range that can be handled
by the internal subtractor amplifier. In general, difference amplifiers should be used in applications where the
common-mode voltage or voltage transients may exceed
the supply voltage.
Table 3-1. Latest Generation Analog Devices In-Amps Summarized1
Product Features
Power
Supply
Current
Typ
AD8221 Precision, high BW
0.9 mA
AD620 General-purpose
0. 9 mA
AD8225 Precision gain = 5
1.1 mA
AD8220R-R, JFET input
750 mA
AD8222 Dual, precision, high BW
1.8 mA
AD8230R-R, zero drift
2.7 mA
AD8250 High BW, programmable gain 3.5 mA
AD8251 High BW, programmable gain 3.5 mA
AD8553 Auto-zero with shutdown
1.1 mA
AD8555 Zero drift dig prog
2.0 mA
AD8556 Dig prog IA with filters
2.0 mA
AD622Low cost
0.9 mA
AD621 Precise gain
0.9 mA
AD623Low cost, S.S.
375 A
AD627 Micropower, S.S.
60 A
–3 dB
BW
Typ
(G = 10)
CMR
G = 10
(dB)
Min
Input
Offset
Voltage
Max
VOS
RTI
Input
Drift Noise2 Bias
(V/C) (nV/√Hz) Current
Max
(G = 10) (nA) Max
560 kHz
800 kHz
900 kHz4
1500 kHz
750 kHz
2 kHz
3.5 MHz
3.5 MHz
1 kHz
700 kHz6
700 kHz6
800 kHz
800 kHz
800 kHz
80 kHz
1003
953
834, 5
100
1003
110
100
100
100
806
806
863
933
903
100
60 V
125 V
150 V
250 mV
120 V
10 V
100 V
100 V
20 V
10 V
10 V
125 V
250 V7
200 V
250 V
0.4
1
0.3
5
0.4
10
1
1
0.1
0.07
0.07
1
2.57
2
3
NOTES
S.S. = single supply.
1
Refer to ADI website at www.analog.com for latest products and specifications.
2
At 1 kHz. RTI noise = √((eni)2 + (eno/G)2).
3
For dc to 60 Hz, 1 k source imbalance.
4
Operating at a gain of 5.
5
For 10 kHz, 1 k source imbalance.
6
Operating at a gain of 70.
Referred to input (RTI).
7
3-1
11 max
16 max
45 typ4
17 typ
11 max
240 typ
13 typ
13 typ
150 typ
32 typ
32 typ
14 typ
17 max7
35 typ
42 typ
1.5
2
1.2
10 pA
2
1
15
15
1
22
54
5
2
25
10
VB
I
A1
IB COMPENSATION
I
A2
IB COMPENSATION
C1
10k�
C2
+VS
10k�
+VS
–IN
R1
24.7k�
400�
Q1
+VS
R2
24.7k�
+VS
+VS
+VS
–VS
400�
Q2
+IN
RG
–VS
OUTPUT
A3
10k�
REF
10k�
–VS
–VS
–VS
–VS
Figure 3-1. AD8221 simplified schematic.
In contrast, an instrumentation amplifier is most commonly
an op amp subtractor with two input buffer amplifiers
(these increase the input Z and thus reduce loading of the
input source). An in-amp should be used when the total
input common-mode voltage plus the input differential
voltage, including transients, is less than the supply voltage. In-amps are also needed in applications where the
highest accuracy, best signal-to-noise ratio, and lowest
input bias current are essential.
Monolithic In-Amp Design—The
Inside Story
High Performance In-Amps
Analog Devices introduced the first high performance
monolithic instrumentation amplifier, the AD520,
in 1971.
In 2003, the AD8221 was introduced. This in-amp is
in a tiny MSOP package and offers increased CMR
at higher bandwidths than other competing in-amps.
It also has improved ac and dc specifications over the
industry-standard AD620 series in-amps.
The AD8221 is a monolithic instrumentation amplifier
based on the classic 3-op amp topology (Figure 3-1).
Input transistors Q1 and Q2 are biased at a constant
current so that any differential input signal will force the
output voltages of A1 and A2 to be equal. A signal applied
to the input creates a current through RG, R1, and R2
such that the outputs of A1 and A2 deliver the correct
voltage. Topologically, Q1, A1, R1 and Q2, A2, R2 can
be viewed as precision current feedback amplifiers. The
amplified differential and common-mode signals are
applied to a difference amplifier, A3, which rejects the
common-mode voltage, but processes the differential
voltage. The difference amplifier has a low output
offset voltage as well as low output offset voltage drift.
Laser-trimmed resistors allow for a highly accurate
in-amp with gain error typically less than 20 ppm and
CMRR that exceeds 90 dB (G = 1).
Using superbeta input transistors and an I B compensation scheme, the AD8221 offers extremely high input
impedance, low I B, low IOS, low I B drift, low input
bias current noise, and extremely low voltage noise of
8 nV/√Hz.
The transfer function of the AD8221 is
G=
49.4 kΩ
+1
RG
49.4 kΩ
G −1
Care was taken to ensure that a user could easily and
accurately set the gain using a single external standard
value resistor.
RG =
Since the input amplifiers employ a current feedback
architecture, the AD8221’s gain bandwidth product
increases with gain, resulting in a system that does not
suffer from the expected bandwidth loss of voltage feedback architectures at higher gains.
In order to maintain precision even at low input levels,
special care was taken with the AD8221’s design and
layout, resulting in an in-amp whose performance
satisfies even the most demanding applications (see
Figures 3-3 and 3-4).
3-2
–IN 1
8
+VS
RG 2
7
VOUT
RG 3
6
+IN 4
5
AD8221
VREF
–VS
OUT1
OUT2
VEE
The AD8222 (Figure 3-5) is a dual version of the
AD8221 in-amp, with similar performance and
specifications. Its small size allows more amplifiers
per PC board. In addition, the AD8222 is the first
in-amp to be specified for differential output performance. It is available in a 4 mm 3 4 mm, 16-lead
LFCSP package.
VCC
A unique pinout enables the AD8221 to meet an
unparalleled CMRR specification of 80 dB at 10 kHz
(G = 1) and 110 dB at 1 kHz (G = 1000). The balanced
pinout, shown in Figure 3-2, reduces the parasitics that
had, in the past, adversely affected CMR performance.
In addition, the new pinout simplifies board layout
because associated traces are grouped. For example,
the gain setting resistor pins are adjacent to the inputs,
and the reference pin is next to the output.
16
15
14
13
–IN1
1
12
–IN2
RG1
2
11
RG2
RG1
3
10
RG2
+IN1
4
9
+IN2
140
CMRR (dB)
100
8
Figure 3-5. AD8222 connection diagram.
For many years, the AD620 has been the industrystandard, high performance, low cost in-amp. The
AD620 is a complete monolithic instrumentation
amplifier offered in both 8-lead DIP and SOIC packages.
The user can program any desired gain from 1 to
1000 using a single external resistor. By design, the
required resistor values for gains of 10 and 100 are
standard 1% metal film resistor values.
GAIN = 100
120
7
VEE
GAIN = 1000
6
REF2
160
5
VCC
Figure 3-2. AD8221 pinout.
REF1
TOP VIEW
GAIN = 10
GAIN = 1000
GAIN = 1
GAIN = 10
80
GAIN = 100
60
40
0.1
1
10
100
1k
10k
100k
1M
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 3-3. CMRR vs. frequency (RTI) of the AD8221.
GAIN = 1000
GAIN (dB)
GAIN = 10
GAIN = 1
–10
–20
–30
100
1k
63
). /54054
2%&
!$
The AD620 (see Figure 3-7) is a second-generation
version of the classic AD524 in-amp and embodies a
modification of its 3-op amp circuit. Laser trimming
of on-chip thin film resistors, R1 and R2, allows the
user to accurately set the gain to 100 within 0.3%
max error, using only one external resistor. Monolithic
construction and laser wafer trimming allow the tight
matching and tracking of circuit components.
10
0
n). Figure 3-6. AD620 pin configuration.
GAIN = 100
30
20
2'
4/06)%7
.OTTO3CALE
50
40
n63 70
60
2' 10k
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
1M
Figure 3-4. AD8221 closed-loop gain vs.
frequency.
10M
A preamp section comprised of Q1 and Q2 provides
additional gain up front. Feedback through the Q1-A1R1 loop and the Q2-A2-R2 loop maintains a constant
collector current through the input devices Q1 and Q2,
3-3
+VS
I1
20�A
VB
I2
20�A
IB
COMPENSATION
IB COMPENSATION
A1
A2
10k�
C2
C1
10k�
OUTPUT
A3
– IN
R3
400�
R1
10k�
R2
Q1
Q2
R4
400�
RG
GAIN
SENSE
10k�
REF
+IN
GAIN
SENSE
–VS
Figure 3-7. A simplified schematic of the AD620.
The AD620 also has superior CMR over a wide frequency range, as shown in Figure 3-9.
The value of RG also determines the transconductance
of the preamp stage. As RG is reduced for larger gains,
the transconductance increases asymptotically to that
of the input transistors.This has important advantages:
First, the open-loop gain is boosted for increasing
programmed gain, thus reducing gain related errors.
Second, the gain bandwidth product (determined by
C1, C2, and the preamp transconductance) increases
with programmed gain, thus optimizing the amplifier’s
frequency response. Figure 3-8 shows the AD620’s
closed-loop gain vs. frequency.
1000
GAIN (V/V)
100
10
1
0.1
100
1k
10k
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
1M
10M
Figure 3-8. AD620 closed-loop gain vs. frequency.
3-4
160
140
120
100
CMR (dB)
thereby impressing the input voltage across the external
gain setting resistor, RG. This creates a differential
gain from the inputs to the A1/A2 outputs given by
G = (R1 + R2)/RG + 1. The unity-gain subtractor, A3,
removes any common-mode signal, yielding a singleended output referred to the REF pin potential.
80
G = 1000
G = 100
G = 10
G=1
60
40
20
0
0.1
1
10
100
1k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
10k
100k
Figure 3-9. AD620 CMR vs. frequency.
1M
Figures 3-10 and 3-11 show the AD620’s gain nonlinearity and small signal pulse response.
100�V
The value of 24.7 k was chosen so that standard
1% resistor values could be used to set the most
popular gains.
Low Cost In-Amps
2V
The AD622 is a low cost version of the AD620 (see
Figure 3-6). The AD622 uses streamlined production
methods to provide most of the performance of the
AD620 at lower cost.
100 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
90
Figures 3-12, 3-13, and 3-14 show the AD622’s CMR
vs. frequency, gain nonlinearity, and closed-loop gain
vs. frequency.
10
0%
.... .... .... ........ .... .... .... ........
160
CMR (dB)
Figure 3-10. AD620 gain nonlinearity
(G = 100, RL = 10 k, vertical scale: 100 V =
10 ppm, horizontal scale: 2 V/div).
20V
140
G = 1000
120
G = 100
100
G = 10
80
G=1
60
40
.... .... .... ........ ........ .... ........
100
90
20
0
0.1
1
10
100
1k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
10k
100k
1M
Figure 3-12. AD622 CMR vs. frequency
((RTI) 0 to 1 k source imbalance).
10
.... .... .... ........ ........ .... ........
0%
10�s
10�s
2V
100
Figure 3-11. Small signal pulse response of
the AD620 (G = 10, RL= 2 k, CL = 100 pF).
90
Finally, the input voltage noise is reduced to a value of
9 nV/√Hz, determined mainly by the collector current
and base resistance of the input devices.
The internal gain resistors, R1 and R2, are trimmed to
an absolute value of 24.7 k, allowing the gain to be
programmed accurately with a single external resistor.
The gain equation is then
G=
Figure 3-13. AD622 Gain nonlinearity
(G = 1, RL = 10 k, vertical scale: 20 V = 2 ppm).
49.4 kΩ
+1
RG
So that
RG =
10
0%
49.4 kΩ
G −1
Where resistor RG is in k.
3-5
Pin-Programmable, Precise Gain In-Amps
1000
The AD621 is similar to the AD620, except that for
gains of 10 and 100 the gain setting resistors are on the
die—no external resistors are used. A single external
jumper (between Pins 1 and 8) is all that is needed to
select a gain of 100. For a gain of 10, leave Pin 1 and
Pin 8 open. This provides excellent gain stability over
temperature, as the on-chip gain resistor tracks the TC
of the feedback resistor. Figure 3-15 is a simplified
schematic of the AD621. With a max total gain error of
0.15% and 5 ppm/C gain drift, the AD621 has much
greater built-in accuracy than the AD620.
GAIN (V/V)
100
10
1
0
100
1k
10k
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
1M
The AD621 may also be operated at gains between 10
and 100 by using an external gain resistor, although gain
error and gain drift over temperature will be degraded.
Using external resistors, device gain is equal to
10M
Figure 3-14. AD622 closed-loop
gain vs. frequency.
G = (R1 + R2)/RG + 1
+VS
7
I1
20�A
VB
20�A
IB
COMPENSATION
I2
IB COMPENSATION
A1
A2
C1
10k�
C2
10k�
A3
– IN
R3
400�
2
R1
Q1
25k� R2
R5
5555.6�
R6
555.6�
1
G = 100
25k�
Q2
10k�
R4
400�
6
10k�
3
+IN
8
G = 100
4
–VS
Figure 3-15. A simplified schematic of the AD621.
3-6
OUTPUT
5
REF
Figures 3-16 and 3-17 show the AD621’s CMR vs.
frequency and closed-loop gain vs. frequency.
Figures 3-18 and 3-19 show the AD621’s gain nonlinearity and small signal pulse response.
160
100�s
140
GAIN = 100
100
90
120
GAIN = 10
100
CMR (dB)
2V
80
60
10
40
0%
20
0
0.1
1
10
100
1k
10k
100k
1M
Figure 3-18. AD621 gain nonlinearity
(G = 10, RL = 10 k, vertical scale: 100 V/div
= 100 ppm/div, horizontal scale 2 V/div).
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 3-16. AD621 CMR vs. frequency.
1000
20mV
10�s
CLOSED-LOOP GAIN (V/V)
100
90
100
10
10
1
0%
0.1
100
1k
10k
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
1M
10M
Figure 3-19. Small signal pulse response of
the AD621 (G = 10, RL = 2 k, CL = 100 pF).
Figure 3-17. AD621 closed-loop gain vs.
frequency.
3-7
n). 63
2' 6/54
2' 62%&
n63
). !$
A single resistor sets the gain from 1 to 1000. The AD8220
operates on both single and dual supplies and is wellsuited for applications where input voltages close to those
of the supply are encountered. In addition, its rail-to-rail
output stage allows for maximum dynamic range, when
constrained by low single-supply voltages.
Auto-Zeroing Instrumentation Amplifiers
4/06)%7
Figure 3-20. AD8220 connection diagram.
The AD8220 is a FET input, gain-programmable, high
performance instrumentation amplifier with a max input
bias current of 10 pA. It also features excellent high
frequency common-mode rejection (see Figure 3-20).
The AD8220 maintains a minimum CMRR of 70 dB
up to 20 kHz, at G = 1. The combination of extremely
high input impedance and high CMRR over frequency
makes the AD8220 useful in applications such as patient
monitoring. In these applications, input impedance is high
and high frequency interference must be rejected.
Auto-zeroing is a dynamic offset and drift cancellation
technique that reduces input referred voltage offset to
the V level, and voltage offset drift to the nV/C level.
The AD8230 (Figure 3-22) is an instrumentation amplifier that utilizes an auto-zeroing topology and combines
it with high common-mode signal rejection.
CMRR (dB)
GAIN = 1000
GAIN = 100
GAIN = 10
BANDWIDTH
LIMITED
100
GAIN = 1
80
100
1k
10k
+VS 2
7
RG
VREF1 3
6
VREF2
5
–IN
AD8230
TOP VIEW
Figure 3-22. AD8230 connection diagram.
60
40
10
VOUT
The internal signal path consists of an active differential sample-and-hold stage (preamp), followed by
a differential amplifier (gain amp). Both amplifiers
implement auto-zeroing to minimize offset and drift.
A fully differential topology increases the immunity
of the signals to parasitic noise and temperature effects.
Amplifier gain is set by two external resistors for
convenient TC matching. The AD8230 can accept
input common-mode voltages within and including
the supply voltages (5 V).
160
120
8
+IN 4
The rail-to-rail output, low power consumption
and small MSOP/CSP package make this precision
instrumentation amplifier attractive for use in multichannel applications.
140
–VS 1
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 3-21. Typical AD8220 CMRR vs. frequency.
3-8
The signal sampling rate is controlled by an on-chip,
10 kHz oscillator and logic to derive the required nonoverlapping clock phases. For simplification of the functional
description, two sequential clock phases, A and B, will
be used to distinguish the order of internal operation as
depicted in Figures 3-23 and 3-24, respectively.
During Phase A, the sampling capacitors are connected
to the input signals at the common-mode potential. The
input signal’s difference voltage, VDIFF, is stored across
the sampling capacitors, CSAMPLE. The common-mode
potential of the input affects CSAMPLE insofar as the
sampling capacitors are at a different common-mode
potential than the preamp. During this period, the gain
amp is disconnected from the preamp so that its output
remains at the level set by the previously sampled input
signal, held on CHOLD in Figure 3-23.
In Phase B, upon sampling the analog input signals,
the input common-mode component is removed.
The common-mode output of the preamp is held at the
reference potential, VREF. When the bottom plates of the
sampling capacitors connect to the output of the preamp,
the input signal common-mode voltage is pulled to the
amplifier’s common-mode voltage, VREF. In this manner,
the sampling capacitors are brought to the same commonmode voltage as the preamp. The remaining differential
signal is presented to the gain amp, refreshing the hold
capacitors’ signal potentials, as shown in Figure 3-24.
Figures 3-25 through 3-28 show the internal workings
of the AD8230 in depth. As noted, both the preamp and
gain amp auto-zero. The preamp auto-zeroes during
phase A, shown in Figure 3-25, while the sampling caps
are connected to the signal source. By connecting the
PREAMP
GAIN AMP
V+IN
VDIFF
+VCM
CHOLD
CSAMPLE
+
–
–
+
VOUT
CHOLD
V–IN
VREF
RG
RF
Figure 3-23. The AD8230 in Phase A sampling phase. The differential component of the input signal
is stored on sampling capacitors, CSAMPLE. The gain amp conditions the signal stored on the hold
capacitors, CHOLD. Gain is set with the RG and RF resistors.
PREAMP
GAIN AMP
V+IN
VDIFF
+VCM
CHOLD
CSAMPLE
+
–
–
+
VOUT
CHOLD
V–IN
RG
VREF
RF
Figure 3-24. In Phase B, the differential signal is transferred to the hold capacitors, refreshing the value
stored on CHOLD. The gain amp continues to condition the signal stored on the hold capacitors, CHOLD.
3-9
preamp differential inputs together, the resulting output
referred offset is connected to an auxiliary input port to the
preamp. Negative feedback operation forces a canceling
potential at the auxiliary port, which is subsequently
held on a storage capacitor, CP_HOLD.
While in Phase A, the gain amp shown in Figure 3-26
reads the previously sampled signal held on the holding
capacitors, CHOLD.The gain amp implements feedforward
offset compensation to allow for transparent nulling of
the main amp and a continuous output signal. A differential
signal regimen is maintained throughout the main amp and
feedforward nulling amp by utilizing a double differential
input topology. The nulling amp compares the input of
the two differential signals. As a result, the offset error
is fed into the null port of the main amp, VNULL, and
stored on CM_HOLD. This operation effectively forces
the differential input potentials at both the signal and
feedback ports of the main amp to be equal. This is the
requirement for zero offset.
PREAMP
V+IN
A
GAIN AMP
B
B
VDIFF
+VCM
CSAMPLE
A
+
–
–
+
B
VOUT
A
B
A
CHOLD
B
A
CHOLD
A
B
V–IN
CP_HOLD
VREF
RG
RF
Figure 3-25. Detailed schematic of the preamp during Phase A. The differential signal is
stored on the sampling capacitors. Concurrently, the preamp nulls its own offset and stores
the correction voltage on its hold capacitors, CP_HOLD.
PREAMP
GAIN AMP
Sn
NULLING AMP
B
A
A
B
fn
B
A
CN_HOLD
CHOLD
+
–
–
CM_HOLD
B
+
B
s
MAIN
AMP
CHOLD
VNULL
VOUT
f
VREF
RG
RF
Figure 3-26. Detailed schematic of the gain amp during Phase A. The main amp conditions
the signal held on the hold capacitors, CHOLD. The nulling amplifier forces the inputs of the
main amp to be equal by injecting a correction voltage into the VNULL port, removing the
offset of the main amp. The correction voltage is stored on CM_HOLD.
3-10
During Phase B, the inputs of the preamp are no longer
shorted, and the sampling capacitors are connected to the
input and output of the preamp as shown in Figure 3-27.
The preamp, having been auto-zeroed in Phase A, has
minimal offset. When the sampling capacitors are connected to the preamp, the common mode of the sampling
capacitors is brought to VREF. The preamp outputs the
difference signal onto the hold capacitors, CHOLD.
The main amp continues to output the gained difference signal, shown in Figure 3-28. Its offset is kept to a
minimum by using the nulling amp’s correction potential
stored on CM_HOLD from the previous phase. During this
phase, the nulling amp compares its two differential inputs
and corrects its own offset by driving a correction voltage
into its nulling port and, ultimately, onto CN_HOLD. In
this fashion, the nulling amp reduces its own offset in
Phase B before it corrects for the main amp’s offset in
the next phase, Phase A.
PREAMP
V+IN
A
GAIN AMP
B
B
VDIFF
+VCM
CSAMPLE
A
+
–
–
+
B
VOUT
A
B
A
CHOLD
B
A
CHOLD
A
B
V–IN
CP_HOLD
VREF
RG
RF
Figure 3-27. Detailed schematic of the preamp during Phase B. The preamp’s offset remains low because
it was corrected in the previous phase. The sampling capacitors connect to the input and output of the
preamp, and the difference voltage is passed onto the holding capacitors, CHOLD.
PREAMP
GAIN AMP
Sn
NULLING AMP
B
A
A
B
fn
B
A
CN_HOLD
CHOLD
+
–
–
CM_HOLD
B
+
B
s
MAIN
AMP
CHOLD
VNULL
VOUT
f
VREF
RG
RF
Figure 3-28. Detailed schematic of the gain amp during Phase B. The nulling amplifier nulls its own
offset by injecting a correction voltage into its own auxiliary port and storing it on CN_HOLD. The main
amplifier continues to condition the differential signal held on CHOLD, yet maintains minimal offset
because its offset was corrected in the previous phase.
3-11
Two external resistors set the gain of the AD8230. The
gain is expressed in the following function:

R 
Gain = 2 1 + F 
RG 

Figure 3-30 shows the AD8230’s common-mode rejection vs. frequency. Figure 3-31 is a plot of AD8230’s
gain flatness vs. frequency at a gain of 10.
+VS
0.1MF
#-27)4(./3/52#%)-"!,!.#%
10MF
0.1MF
#-2D"
–VS
10MF
2
4
AD8230
VREF2
5
VREF1
6
1
RG
8
#-27)4(K63/52#%)-"!,!.#%
VOUT
7
RF
3
RG
K
K
&2%15%.#9(Z
Figure 3-30. Common-mode rejection vs. frequency.
Figure 3-29. Gain setting.
Table 3-2. Gains Using Standard 1% Resistors
RF
2
10
50
100
200
500
1000
0 V (short)None
2 kV
8.06 kV
499 V
12.1 kV
200 V
9.76 kV
100 V
10 kV
200 V
49.9 kV
200 V
100 kV
RG
Actual Gain
2
10
50.5
99.6
202
501
1002
'!).D"
Gain
Figure 3-29 and Table 3-2 provide an example of some
gain settings. As Table 3-2 shows, the AD8230 accepts a
wide range of resistor values. Since the instrumentation
apmplifier has finite driving capability, ensure that the
output load in parallel with the sum of the gain setting
resistors is greater than 2 kV.
RL ( RF + RG ) > 2 kΩ
Offset voltage drift at high temperature can be minimized
by keeping the value of the feedback resistor, RF, small.
This is due to the junction leakage current on the RG
pin, Pin 7.
n
K
K
K
&2%15%.#9(Z
Figure 3-31. Gain vs. frequency, G = 10.
The AD8553 is a precision current-mode auto-zero
instrumentation amplifier capable of single-supply
operation. The current-mode correction topology
results in excellent accuracy, without the need for
trimmed resistors on the die.
3-12
2'
2'
n).
'.$
).
6##
6/54
62%&
6&"
%.!",%
AD8553
The pinout of the AD8553 allows the user to access the signal
current from the output of the voltage-to-current converter
(Pin 5). The user can choose to use the AD8553 as a
current-output device instead of a voltage-output device.
The AD8555 is a zero-drift, sensor signal amplifier with
digitally programmable gain and output offset. Designed
to easily and accurately convert variable pressure sensor
and strain bridge outputs to a well-defined output voltage
range, the AD8555 also accurately amplifies many other
differential or single-ended sensor outputs.
Figure 3-32. AD8553 connection diagram.
Figure 3-32 is the AD8553 connection diagram while
Figure 3-33 shows a simplified schematic illustrating
the basic operation of the AD8553 (without correction).
The circuit consists of a voltage-to-current amplifier
(M1 to M6), followed by a current-to-voltage amplifier
(R2 and A1). Application of a differential input voltage
forces a current through external resistor R1, resulting
in conversion of the input voltage to a signal current.
Transistors M3 to M6 transfer twice this signal current
to the inverting input of the op amp A1. Amplifier A1 and
external resistor R2 form a current-to-voltage converter
to produce a rail-to-rail output voltage at VOUT.
Figure 3-34 shows the pinout and Figure 3-35 the
simplified schematic.
6$$ &),4$)'/54
$)'). I
M5
IR1 =
VIN+
VIN+ – VIN–
R1
M1
6/54
6#,!-0
60/3
Figure 3-34. AD8555 connection diagram.
The AD8555 (and AD8556) use both auto-zeroing
and “chopping” techniques to maintin zero drift. A1,
A2, R1, R2, R3, P1, and P2 form the first gain stage of
the differential amplifier. A1 and A2 are auto-zeroed op
amps that minimize input offset errors. P1 and P2 are
digital potentiometers, guaranteed to be monotonic.
Programming P1 and P2 allows the first stage gain to
be varied from 4.0 to 6.4 with 7-bit resolution, giving a
fine gain adjustment resolution of 0.37%. R1, R2, R3,
P1, and P2 each have a similar temperature coefficient,
so the first stage gain temperature coefficient is lower
than 100 ppm/8C.
C2
I – IR1
R2
2IR1
VIN–
A1
I + IR1
M3
2I
633
M6
I – IR1
M2
4/06)%7
.OTTO3CALE
An external reference voltage is applied to the noninverting input of A1 for output-offset adjustment. Because
the AD8553 is essentially a chopper in-amp, some type of
low-pass filtering of the ouput is usually required. External
capacitor C2 is used to filter out high frequency noise.
R1
!$
6.%' Op amp A1 is a high precision auto-zero amplifier. This
amplifier preserves the performance of the autocorrection
current-mode amplifier topology while offering the user
a true voltage-in, voltage-out instrumentation amplifier.
Offset errors are corrected internally.
I
M4
VBIAS
VOUT = VREF +
VREF
2I
Figure 3-33. AD8553 simplified schematic.
3-13
2R2
R1
VIN+ – VIN–
VDD
VCLAMP
VDD
VNEG
A1
R4
P3
VDD
A2
VPOS
VDD
P1
RF
A3
R3
VDD
R6
VSS
R1
VSS
A5
A4
VOUT
P2
VSS
R2
R5
VDD
FILT/
DIGOUT
R7
VSS
P4
VSS
DAC
VSS
Figure 3-35. AD8555 simplified schematic.
A3, R4, R5, R6, R7, P3, and P4 form the second gain stage
of the differential amplifier. A3 is also an auto-zeroed op
amp that minimizes input offset errors. P3 and P4 are
digital potentiometers, allowing the second stage gain
to be varied from 17.5 to 200 in eight steps; they allow
the gain to be varied over a wide range. R4, R5, R6, R7,
P3, and P4 each have a similar temperature coefficient,
so the second stage gain temperature coefficient is lower
than 100 ppm/8C.
A5 implements a voltage buffer, which provides the
positive supply to the amplifier output buffer A4. Its
function is to limit VOUT to a maximum value, useful for
driving analog-to-digital converters (ADC) operating on
supply voltages lower thanVDD.The input to A5,VCLAMP,
has a very high input resistance. It should be connected
to a known voltage and not left floating. However, the
high input impedance allows the clamp voltage to be
set using a high impedance source (e.g., a potential
divider). If the maximum value of VOUT does not need
to be limited, VCLAMP should be connected to VDD.
A4 implements a rail-to-rail input and output unity-gain
voltage buffer. The output stage of A4 is supplied from
a buffered version of VCLAMP instead of VDD, allowing
the positive swing to be limited. The maximum output
current is limited between 5 to 10 mA.
An 8-bit digital-to-analog converter (DAC) is used to
generate a variable offset for the amplifier output. This
DAC is guaranteed to be monotonic. To preserve the
ratiometric nature of the input signal, the DAC references
are driven from VSS and VDD, and the DAC output can
swing from VSS (Code 0) to VDD (Code 255). The 8-bit
resolution is equivalent to 0.39% of the difference between
VDD and VSS (e.g., 19.5 mV with a 5 V supply). The DAC
output voltage (VDAC) is given approximately by
 Code + 0.5 
VDAC ≈ 
(V − VSS ) + VSS
 256  DD
The temperature coefficient of VDAC is lower than
200 ppm/8C.
3-14
The amplifier output voltage (VOUT) is given by
VOUT = GAIN (VPOS − VNEG ) + VDAC
60
CLOSED-LOOP GAIN (dB)
where GAIN is the product of the first and second
stage gains.
VS = 2.5V
GAIN = +70
120
CMRR (dB)
VS = 2.5V
GAIN = +1280
40
GAIN = +70
20
0
80
1k
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
1M
Figure 3-37. AD8555 closed-loop gain vs.
frequency measured at output pin.
40
0
100
10k
1k
10k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
100k
The AD8556 is essentially the same product as the
AD8555, except that the former includes internal RFI
filtering. The block diagram for the AD8556 is shown in
Figure 3-38. For theory of operation, refer to the previous
section that covers the AD8555.
1M
Figure 3-36. AD8555 CMRR vs. frequency.
Figures 3-36 and 3-37 show the AD8555’s CMRR vs.
frequency and its closed-loop gain vs. frequency.
See the AD8555 product data sheet for more details.
DIGIN
VDD
VCLAMP
VDD
1 +IN
EMI
FILTER
1 +IN
EMI
FILTER
2
OUT
3
–IN
VSS
VDD
VPOS
2
DAC
LOGIC
A5
VSS
A1
OUT
R5
3
–IN
P4
R7
R2
VSS
P2
VDD
EMI
FILTER
R3
VNEG
2
EMI
FILTER
OUT
VSS
A3
OUT
–IN
VDD
3
RF
EMI
FILTER
1 +IN
2
A4
OUT
–IN
VSS
A2
–IN
2
P1
VDD
1 +IN
1 +IN
R1
3
R4
VSS
R6
P3
AD8556
VSS
FILT/DIGOUT
Figure 3-38. AD8556 block diagram showing EMI/RFI built-in filters.
3-15
3
VOUT
+VS
+VS
+VS
VB
–IN
4006
Q1
A1
–VS
4006
Q2
R2
C2
UNITYGAIN
BUFFERS
A2
+IN
–VS
C1
R1
15k6
+VS
3k6
A3
3k6
GAIN-OF-5
DIFFERENCE AMPLIFIER
–VS
15k6
Figure 3-39. AD8225 simplified schematic.
Fixed Gain (Low Drift) In-Amps
VOUT
+VS
VREF
–VS
130
The AD8225 has a wide gain bandwidth product,
resulting from its being compensated for a fixed gain of
5, as opposed to the usual unity-gain compensation of
variable gain in-amps. High frequency performance is
also enhanced by the innovative pinout of the AD8225.
Since Pin 1 and Pin 8 are uncommitted, Pin 1 may be
connected to Pin 4. Since Pin 4 is also ac common, the
stray capacitance at Pins 2 and 3 is balanced.
Figure 3-40 shows the AD8225’s CMR vs. frequency
while Figure 3-41 shows its gain nonlinearity.
120
110
CMR (dB)
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
1
10
100
1k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
10k
100k
Figure 3-40. AD8225 CMR vs. frequency.
4
100mV
2V
3
100
2 90
NONLINEARITY (ppm)
The AD8225 is a precision, gain-of-5, monolithic
in-amp. Figure 3-39 shows that it is a 3-op amp instrumentation amplifier. The unity-gain input buffers
consist of superbeta NPN transistors Q1 and Q2 and
op amps A1 and A2. These transistors are compensated
so that their input bias currents are extremely low,
typically 100 pA or less. As a result, current noise is
also low, only 50 fA/√Hz. The input buffers drive a
gain-of-5 difference amplifier. Because the 3 k and
15 k resistors are ratio matched, gain stability is better
than 5 ppm/ C over the rated temperature range.
1
0
–1
–2 10
0
–3
–4
–10
0
OUTPUT VOLTAGE (V)
Figure 3-41. AD8225 gain nonlinearity.
3-16
10
Monolithic In-Amps Optimized for
Single-Supply Operation
Single-supply in-amps have special design problems
that need to be addressed. The input stage must be able
to amplify signals that are at ground potential (or very
close to ground), and the output stage needs to be able
to swing to within a few millivolts of ground or
the supply rail. Low power supply current is also
important. And, when operating from low power
supply voltages, the in-amp needs to have an adequate
gain bandwidth product, low offset voltage drift, and
good CMR vs. gain and frequency.
The AD623 is an instrumentation amplifier based
on the 3-op amp in-amp circuit, modified to ensure
operation on either single- or dual-power supplies, even
at common-mode voltages at, or even below, the negative
supply rail (or below ground in single-supply operation).
Other features include rail-to-rail output voltage swing,
low supply current, MSOP packaging, low input and
output voltage offset, microvolt/dc offset level drift,
high common-mode rejection, and only one external
resistor to set the gain.
As shown in Figure 3-42, the input signal is applied to
PNP transistors acting as voltage buffers and dc level
shifters. A resistor trimmed to within 0.1% of 50 k
in each amplifier’s (A1 and A2) feedback path ensures
accurate gain programmability.
The output voltage at Pin 6 is measured with respect
to the reference potential at Pin 5. The impedance of the
reference pin is 100 k. Internal ESD clamping diodes
allow the input, reference, output, and gain terminals
of the AD623 to safely withstand overvoltages of 0.3 V
above or below the supplies. This is true for all gains,
and with power on or off. This last case is particularly
important, since the signal source and the in-amp may
be powered separately. If the overvoltage is expected to
exceed this value, the current through these diodes should
be limited to 10 mA, using external current limiting
resistors (see Input Protection Basics for ADI In-Amps
section in Chapter 5). The value of these resistors is
defined by the in-amp’s noise level, the supply voltage,
and the required overvoltage protection needed.
The bandwidth of the AD623 is reduced as the gain
is increased since A1 and A2 are voltage feedback op
amps. However, even at higher gains, the AD623 still
has enough bandwidth for many applications.
+VS
7
1.5�A
+
–A1
Q1
+IN
3
50k�
4
–VS
The differential output is
+VS
7

100 kΩ 
 VO = 1 + R  VC


G
1.5�A
–IN
where RG is in k.
2
The differential voltage is then converted to a single-ended
voltage using the output difference amplifier, which also
rejects any common-mode signal at the output of the
input amplifiers.
Since all the amplifiers can swing to either supply rail,
as well as have their common-mode range extended to
below the negative supply rail, the range over which the
AD623 can operate is further enhanced.
Note that the base currents of Q1 and Q2 flow directly
out of the input terminals, unlike dual-supply, inputcurrent-compensated in-amps such as the AD620.
Since the inputs (i.e., the bases of Q1 and Q2) can
operate at ground (i.e., 0 V or, more correctly, 200 mV
below ground), it is not possible to provide input
current compensation for the AD623. However, the
input bias current of the AD623 is still very small: only
25 nA max.
50k�
1
GAIN
RESISTOR
8
50k�
50k�
50k�
–
A3
+
50k�
OUTPUT
6
REF
5
–
A2
+
Q2
4
–VS
Figure 3-42. AD623 simplified schematic.
The AD623’s gain is resistor-programmed by R G
or more precisely by whatever impedance appears
between Pins 1 and 8. Figure 3-43 shows the gain vs.
frequency of the AD623. The AD623 is laser-trimmed
to achieve accurate gains using 0.1% to 1% tolerance
resistors.
3-17
70
120
VREF = 2.5V
60
110
50
40
x10
90
30
CMR (dB)
GAIN (dB)
x1000
100
20
10
x1
80
x100
70
60
0
–10
50
–20
40
–30
100
1k
10k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
100k
30
1M
VREF = 2.5V
1
10
100
1k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
10k
100k
Figure 3-44. AD623 CMR vs. frequency (VS = 5 V).
Figure 3-43. AD623 closed-loop gain
vs. frequency.
Figure 3-45 shows the gain nonlinearity of the AD623.
Table 3-3. Required Value of Gain Resistor
Desired Gain 2
5
10 20 33 40 50 65 100 200 500 1000 1% Std.
Value of RG () 100 k 24.9 k 11 k 5.23 k 3.09 k 2.55 k 2.05 k 1.58 k 1.02 k 499 200 100 Calculated Gain
Using 1% Resistors
2
5.02
10.09
20.12
33.36
40.21
49.78
64.29
99.04
201.4
501
1001
Figure 3-45. AD623 gain nonlinearity
(G = –10, 50 ppm/div).
Table 3-3 shows required values of RG for various gains.
Note that for G = 1, the RG terminals are unconnected
(RG = ). For any arbitrary gain, RG can be calculated
using the formula
Figure 3-46 shows the small signal pulse response of
the AD623.
RG = 100 k/(G – 1)
Figure 3-44 shows the AD623’s CMR vs. frequency.
Note that the CMR increases with gain up to a gain of
100 and that CMR also remains high over frequency, up
to 200 Hz. This ensures the attenuation of power line
common-mode signals (and their harmonics).
Figure 3-46. AD623 small signal pulse response
(G = 10, RL = 10 k, CL = 100 pF).
3-18
The AD627 is a single-supply, micropower instrumentation amplifier that can be configured for gains between
5 and 1000 using just a single external resistor. It provides
a rail-to-rail output voltage swing using a single 3 V to
30 V power supply. With a quiescent supply current of
only 60 A (typical), its total power consumption is less
than 180 W, operating from a 3 V supply.
Figure 3-47 is a simplified schematic of the AD627.
The AD627 is a true instrumentation amplifier built
using two feedback loops. Its general properties are
similar to those of the classic 2-op amp instrumentation
amplifier configuration and can be regarded as such,
but internally the details are somewhat different. The
AD627 uses a modified current feedback scheme,
which, coupled with interstage feedforward frequency
compensation, results in a much better CMRR at
frequencies above dc (notably the line frequency of
50 Hz to 60 Hz) than might otherwise be expected of
a low power instrumentation amplifier.
As shown in Figure 3-47, A1 completes a feedback loop,
which, in conjunction with V1 and R5, forces a constant
collector current in Q1. Assume for the moment that
the gain-setting resistor (RG) is not present. Resistors
R2 and R1 complete the loop and force the output of
A1 to be equal to the voltage on the inverting terminal
with a gain of (almost exactly) 1.25. A nearly identical
feedback loop completed by A2 forces a current in Q2,
which is substantially identical to that in Q1, and A2 also
provides the output voltage. When both loops are balanced, the gain from the noninverting terminal to VOUT
is equal to 5, whereas the gain from the output of A1 to
VOUT is equal to –4. The inverting terminal gain of A1
(1.25), times the gain of A2 (–4), makes the gain from
the inverting and noninverting terminals equal.
The differential mode gain is equal to 1 + R4/R3,
nominally 5, and is factory trimmed to 0.01% final
accuracy (AD627B typ). Adding an external gain setting
resistor (RG) increases the gain by an amount equal to
(R4 + R1)/RG. The gain of the AD627 is given by the
following equation:
 200 kΩ 
G = 5+

 RG 
Laser trims are performed on resistors R1 through R4
to ensure that their values are as close as possible to
the absolute values in the gain equation. This ensures
low gain error and high common-mode rejection at all
practical gains.
Figure 3-48 shows the AD627’s CMR vs. frequency.
120
110
100
90
G = 1000
80
CMR (dB)
Low Power, Single-Supply In-Amps
70
G = 100
60
50
G=5
40
30
20
10
0
1
10
100
1k
10k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 3-48. AD627 CMR vs. frequency.
EXTERNAL GAIN RESISTOR
REF
R1
100k�
R2
25k�
+VS
–IN
2k�
R4
100k�
RG
R3
25k�
2k�
Q2
Q1
–VS
+VS
+IN
–VS
A1
A2
R5
200k�
OUTPUT
R6
200k�
V1
–VS
Figure 3-47. AD627 simplified schematic.
3-19
100k
Gain-Programmable In-Amps
Figures 3-49 and 3-50 show the AD627’s gain vs.
frequency and gain nonlinearity.
The AD8250 and AD8251 (Figure 3-52) are digitally gainprogrammable instrumentation amplifiers that have high
(G) input impedances and low distortion, making them
suitable for sensor interfacing and driving high sample rate
analog-to-digital converters. The two products are nearly
identical, except for their gain ranges. The AD8250 has
programmable gains of 1, 2, 5, and 10, while the AD8251
has a range of 1, 2, 4, and 8 (for binary applications). Both
products have high bandwidths of 10 MHz, low distortion,
and a settling time of 0.5 s to 0.01%. Input offset drift and
gain drift are only 1 V/C and 10 ppm/C, respectively. In
addition to their wide input common-voltage range, they
boast a high common-mode rejection of 80 dB at
G = 1 from dc to 100 kHz. The combination of precision
dc performance coupled with high speed capabilities makes
the AD8250 and AD8251 excellent candidates for data
acquisition and medical applications. Furthermore, these
monolithic solutions simplify design and manufacturing,
while boosting their performance, by maintaining a tight
match of internal resistors and amplifiers.
70
60
G = 1000
CLOSED-LOOP GAIN (dB)
50
40
G = 100
30
20
10
G = 10
G=5
0
–10
–20
–30
100
1k
10k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
100k
Figure 3-49. AD627 closed-loop gain
vs. frequency.
M6$)6)3)/.
+VS
–IN
A1
PPM6%24
$)6)3)/.
DGND
WR
A1
A2
6/54
6$)6)3)/.
GAIN
LOGIC
A3
OUT
A2
+IN
Figure 3-50. AD627 gain nonlinearity
(VS = 2.5 V, G = 5, 4 ppm/vertical division).
–VS
The AD627 also has excellent dynamic response, as
shown in Figure 3-51.
REF
Figure 3-52. AD8250 and AD8251 simplified
schematic.
The AD8250 and AD8251 user interfaces are comprised
of a parallel port that allows users to set the gain in one
of three different ways (Figure 3-52). A 2-bit word sent to
A1 and A2 via a bus may be latched using the CLK input.
An alternative is to set the gain within 1 s by using the
gain port in transparent mode. The last method is to strap
A1 and A2 to a high or low voltage potential, permanently
setting the gain.
Figure 3-51. Small signal pulse response of the
AD627 (VS = 5 V, G = +10, RL = 20 k, CL = 50 pF,
20 s/horizontal division, 20 mV/vertical division).
The AD8250 and AD8251 are available in a 10-lead
MSOP package and are specified over the –40C to
+125C temperature range, making them an excellent
solution for applications where size and packing density
are important considerations. To simplify matters, their
pinout was chosen to optimize layout and increase ac
performance.
3-20
Chapter IV
MONOLITHIC DIFFERENCE AMPLIFIERS
Difference (Subtractor) Amplifier Products
Monolithic difference amplifiers are a special category
of in-amps that are usually designed to be used in applications where large dc or ac common-mode voltages
are present. This includes many general current sensing
applications, such as motor control, battery chargers,
and power converters. In addition, there are numerous
high common-mode voltage automotive current sensing
applications, including: battery cell voltage monitoring,
transmission controls, fuel injection controls, engine
management, suspension controls, electronic steering,
electronic parking brake, and hybrid vehicle drive/hybrid
battery control. Because these amplifiers are typically
used to sense current by accurately amplifying the small
differential voltage across a shunt resistor in the load
path, they are often called current shunt amplifiers.
The AD8200 family of current shunt amplifiers is based
on a traditional difference amplifier input stage which
includes a resistor-divider configuration. These on-chip
precision resistors provide matching to within 0.01%,
which results in very good total error when compared
with a difference amplifier built from discrete op amps
and resistors. Unlike the AD8200 amplifiers, which can
withstand high common-mode input voltages by dividing
these voltages down at the input, the AD8210 amplifiers
tolerate the high common-mode input voltages by virtue
of the high breakdown voltages of their input transistors.
This provides numerous advantages over the AD8200
series amplifiers, including higher bandwidth, higher
input impedance, and lower overall noise amplification.
Combined, these advantages reduce total system error.
Table 4-1 provides a performance summary of Analog
Devices difference amplifier products.
Table 4-1. Latest Generation of Analog Devices Difference Amps Summarized1
Product Features
Power
Supply
Current
Typ
–3 dB
BW
Typ
(G = 10)
CMR
G = 10
(dB)
Min
Input
Offset
Voltage
Max
AD8202
AD8203
AD8205
AD8206
AD8210
AD8212
AD8213
AD8130
AD628
AD629
AD626
AMP03
250 A
250 A
1 mA
1 mA
500 A
200 A
1.3 mA11
12 mA
1.6 mA
0.9 mA
1.5 mA
3.5 mA
50 kHz
60 kHz7
50 kHz8
100 kHz3
500 kHz3
500 kHz
500 kHz
270 MHz
600 kHz15
500 kHz
100 kHz
3 MHz
803, 4, 5
805, 7
804, 5, 6
763, 9
1003, 5
90
100
8312, 13
7515
7712
5516
8512
1 mV6 10
1 mV6 10
2 mV6 15 typ
2 mV6 15 typ
1 mV6 5 typ
1 mV
10
1 mV
10
1.8 mV 3.5 mV
1.5 mV 4
1 mV
6
500 V 1
400 VNS
S.S., 28 V CMV, G = 20
S.S., 28 V CMV, G = 14
S.S., 65 V CMV, G = 50
S.S., 65 V CMV, G = 20
S.S., current shunt monitor
Adjustable gain; CMV up to 500 V10
Dual channel
270 MHz receiver
High CMV
High CMV, G = 1
High CMV
High BW, G = 1
NOTES
NS = not specified, NA = not applicable, S.S. = single supply.
1
Refer to ADI website at www.analog.com for latest products and specifications.
2
At 1 kHz. RTI noise = √(eni)2 + (eno/G)2.
3
Operating at a gain of 20.
4
For 10 kHz, <2 k source imbalance.
5
DC to 10 kHz.
6
Referred to input (RTI).
7
Operating at a gain of 14.
8
Operating at a gain of 50.
9
DC to 20 kHz.
10
With inexpensive external transistor.
11
Note that this is 0.65 mA per channel.
12
Operating at a gain of 1.
13
At frequency = 4 MHz.
14
At frequency  10 kHz.
15
Operating at a gain of 0.1.
16
f = 10 kHz, VCM = 6 V.
4-1
VOS
Drift
(V/C)
Max
RTI
Noise2
(nV/√Hz)
(G = 10)
300 typ3
300 typ7
500 typ8
500 typ3
80 typ3
100 typ
70 typ
12.5 typ12, 14
300 typ15
550 typ12
250 typ
750 typ12
The AD8200 family of current sensing difference amplifiers has multiple gain options, which provide design
flexibility for the following important trade-offs:
63
! !
1.) The shunt resistance value vs. the power dissipated in
the circuit being measured
). 2!
' 2#
n). 2!
n
RG
RB
RC
RC
2&
2#
Figure 4-1. AD8202 connection diagram.
Any common-mode voltage applied to both inputs will
keep the bridge balanced and the A1 output at zero.
Because the resistor networks are carefully matched,
the common-mode signal rejection approaches this
ideal state. However, if the signals applied to the inputs
differ, the result is a difference at the input to A1. A1
responds by adjusting its output to drive R B, by way of
RG, to adjust the voltage at its inverting input until it
matches the voltage at its noninverting input.
100k
A1
RB
2&
2'
Figure 4-2 provides more details. The preamp incorporates a dynamic bridge (subtractor) circuit. Identical
networks (within the shaded areas) consisting of R A,
R B, RC, and RG attenuate input signals applied to Pins
1 and 8. Note that when equal amplitude signals are
asserted at inputs 1 and 8, and the output of A1 is equal
to the common potential (i.e., zero), the two attenuators
form a balanced-bridge network. When the bridge is
balanced, the differential input voltage at A1, and thus
its output, will be zero.
RA
RCM
/54
The AD8202 consists of a preamp and buffer arranged
as shown in Figure 4-1.
RA
#/-
Similarly, the AD8205 has a gain of 50, for use in
applications where it is most important to minimize the
power dissipation in the resistive shunt. This higher gain
is used with lower resistance shunts, which, of course,
have a lower output voltage. This slightly reduces the
signal-to-noise performance of the system.
1
!
n
2"
The automotive industry standard calls for a gain of 20,
which, in most cases, gives an excellent trade-off between
all three variables. However, there are conditions which
favor other gains. For example, the AD8203 operates at a
gain of 14. This allows for convenient scaling of the output to accommodate both 5 V and 3.3 V A/D converters,
while still using the same value resistive shunt.
–IN
'
3.) The shunt resistance value vs. the amplifier gain
needed
8
!$
!
2.) The shunt resistance value vs. the signal-to-noise
ratio
+IN
2'
2"
3
(TRIMMED)
A3
5
RF
AD8202
2
COM
Figure 4-2. AD8202 simplified schematic.
4-2
A2
RF
RCM
RG
4
By attenuating voltages at Pins 1 and 8, the amplifier
inputs are held within the power supply range, even if
the input levels of Pins 1 and 8 exceed the supply or
fall below common (ground). The input network also
attenuates normal (differential) mode voltages. RC
and RG form an attenuator that scales A1 feedback,
forcing large output signals to balance relatively small
differential inputs. The resistor ratios establish the
preamp gain at 10.
to the AD8203. The two products are almost identical,
except for their internal preset gains and their power
consumption.
Because the differential input signal is attenuated and
then amplified to yield an overall gain of 10, the
amplifier A1 operates at a higher noise gain, multiplying
deficiencies such as input offset voltage and noise with
respect to Pins 1 and 8.
In typical applications, the AD8205 is used to measure
current by amplifying the voltage across a current shunt
placed across the inputs.
To minimize these errors while extending the commonmode range, a dedicated feedback loop is employed to
reduce the range of common-mode voltage applied to
A1 for a given overall range at the inputs. By offsetting
the range of voltage applied to the compensator, the
input common-mode range is also offset to include
voltages more negative than the power supply. Amplifier A3 detects the common-mode signal applied to A1
and adjusts the voltage on the matched RCM resistors
to reduce the common-mode voltage range at the A1
inputs. By adjusting the common voltage of these resistors, the common-mode input range is extended while
the normal mode signal attenuation is reduced, leading
to better performance referred to input.
The output of the dynamic bridge taken from A1 is
connected to Pin 3 by way of a 100 k series resistor,
provided for low-pass filtering and gain adjustment.
The resistors in the input networks of the preamp and
the buffer feedback resistors are ratio-trimmed for
high accuracy.
The output of the preamp drives a gain-of-2 buffer
amplifier, A2, implemented with carefully matched
feedback resistors, R F.
AD8205 Difference Amplifier
The AD8205 is a single-supply difference amplifier that
uses a unique architecture to accurately amplify small
differential current shunt voltages in the presence of
rapidly changing common-mode voltages. It is offered
in both packaged and die form.
The gain of the AD8205 is 50 V/V, with an accuracy of
1.2%. This accuracy is guaranteed over the operating
temperature range of –40C to +125C. The die temperature range is –40C to +150C with a guaranteed
gain accuracy of 1.3%.
The input offset is less than 2 mV referred to the input at
25C, and 4.5 mV maximum referred to the input over
the full operating temperature range for the packaged
part. The die input offset is less than 6 mV referred to
the input over the die operating temperature range.
The AD8205 operates with a single supply from
4.5 V to 10 V (absolute maximum = 12.5 V). The
supply current is less than 2 mA.
High accuracy trimming of the internal resistors allows
the AD8205 to have a common-mode rejection ratio
better than 78 dB from dc to 20 kHz.The common-mode
rejection ratio over the operating temperature is 76 dB
for both the die and the packaged part.
The output offset can be adjusted from 0.05 V to 4.8 V
(V+ = 5 V) for unipolar and bipolar operation.
The AD8205 consists of two amplifiers (A1 and A2), a
resistor network, a small voltage reference, and a bias
circuit (not shown). See Figure 4-3.
The two-stage system architecture of the AD8202
(Figure 4-2) enables the user to incorporate a low-pass
filter prior to the output buffer. By separating the gain
into two stages, a full-scale, rail-to-rail signal from the
preamp can be filtered at Pin 3, and a half-scale signal
resulting from filtering can be restored to full scale
by the output buffer amp. The source resistance seen
by the inverting input of A2 is approximately 100 k,
to minimize the effects of A2’s input bias current.
Typically, this current is quite small, and errors
resulting from applications that mismatch the resistance
are correspondingly small. The simplified schematic and
theory of operation given for the AD8202 also applies
4-3
–IN
RA
+IN
RA
A1
RB
RB
RC
RC
250mV
GND
RF
RF
RD
RD
A2
VOUT
VREF1
AD8205
RE
RF
RREF
RREF
VREF2
Figure 4-3. AD8205 simplified schematic.
The set of input attenuators preceding A1 consists of RA,
RB, and RC, which reduces the common-mode voltage to
match the input voltage range of A1.The two attenuators
form a balanced-bridge network.When the bridge is balanced, the differential voltage created by a common-mode
voltage is 0 V at the inputs of A1. The input attenuation
ratio is 1/16.7. The combined series resistance of RA, RB,
and RC is approximately 200 k  20%.
By attenuating the voltages at Pin 1 and Pin 8, the A1
amplifier inputs are held within the power supply range,
even if Pin 1 and Pin 8 exceed the supply or fall below
common (ground). A reference voltage of 250 mV
biases the attenuator above ground. This allows
the amplifier to operate in the presence of negative
common-mode voltages.
The input network also attenuates normal (differential)
mode voltages. A1 amplifies the attenuated signal by 26.
The input and output of this amplifier are differential to
maximize the ac common-mode rejection.
A2 converts the differential voltage from A1 into a singleended signal and provides further amplification.The gain
of this second stage is 32.15.
The reference inputs, VREF1 and VREF2, are tied through
resistors to the positive input of A2, which allows the
output offset to be adjusted anywhere in the output
operating range. The gain is 1 V/V from the reference
pins to the output when the reference pins are used
in parallel. The gain is 0.5 V/V when they are used to
divide the supply.
The ratios of Resistors RA, RB, RC, RD, and RF are
trimmed to a high level of precision to allow the
common-mode rejection ratio to exceed 80 dB. This
is accomplished by laser trimming the resistor ratio
matching to better than 0.01%.
The AD8210 operates with a single supply between
4.5 V to 5.5 V. The supply current is typically less
than 2 mA.
The AD8210 is comprised of two main blocks: a
differential amplifier and an instrumentation amplifier. A
load current flowing through the external shunt resistor
produces a voltage at the input terminals. The input
terminals are connected to the differential amplifier (A1)
by Resistors R1 and R2. A1 nulls the voltage appearing
across its own input terminals by adjusting (balancing)
the current through R1 and R2 with Transistors Q1 and
Q2. When the input signal to the AD8210 is zero, the
currents in R1 and R2 are equal. When the differential
signal is nonzero, the current increases through one
of the resistors and decreases in the other. The current
difference is proportional to the size and polarity of
the input signal. Since the differential input voltage is
converted into a current, common-mode rejection is not
dependent on resistor matching; therefore, both high
accuracy and performance are provided throughout the
wide common-mode voltage range.
The differential currents through QI and Q2 are
converted into a differential voltage due to R3 and R4.
A2 is configured as an instrumentation amplifier,
and this differential input signal is converted into a
single-ended output voltage by A2.The gain is internally
set with thin-film resistors to 20 V/V.
The output reference voltage is easily programmed by the
VREF1 and VREF2 pins. In a typical configuration, VREF1
is connected to VCC while VREF2 is connected to GND.
In this case, the output is centered at VCC/2 when the
input signal is zero.
The total gain of 50 is made up of the input attenuation
of 1/16.7 multiplied by the first stage gain of 26 and the
second stage gain of 32.15.
I SHUNT
R SHUNT
R1
The output stage is Class A with a PNP pull-up transistor
and a 300 A current sink pull-down.
The AD8206 is nearly identical to the AD8205, except
for gain and power consumption. Please see the AD8205
circuit description for AD8206 theory of operation.
The AD8210 is a current shunt monitor IC. Figure 4-4
shows the block diagram.
The gain of the AD8210 is 20 V/V, with an accuracy of
0.7%. This accuracy is guaranteed over the operating
temperature range of –408C to +1258C.
VOUT = (I SHUNT × R SHUNT) × 20
R2
VS
AD8210
A1
Q1
Q2
VREF1
A2
R3
VOUT
R4
VREF 2
GND
Figure 4-4. AD8210 block diagram.
4-4
The differential amplifier topology of the AMP03 serves
both to amplify the difference between two signals and
to provide extremely high rejection of the common-mode
input voltage. With a typical common-mode rejection of
100 dB, the AMP03 solves common problems encountered in instrumentation design. It is ideal for performing
either the addition or subtraction of two input signals
without using expensive externally matched precision
resistors. Because of its high CMRR over frequency,
the AMP03 is an ideal general-purpose amplifier for
data acquisition systems that must operate in a noisy
environment. Figures 4-8 and 4-9 show the AMP03’s
CMRR and closed-loop gain vs. frequency.
140
130
CMRR (dB)
120
110
+125°C
+25°C
100
90
–40°C
80
70
60
100
1k
10k
100k
120
FREQUENCY (Hz)
TA = 25C
VS = 15V
110
Figure 4-5. AD8210 CMRR vs. frequency and
temperature (common-mode voltage < 5 V).
100
90
80
130
CMRR (dB)
140
+25°C
120
70
60
50
CMRR (dB)
40
110
–40°C
30
+125°C
20
100
10
90
0
80
1
10
100
1k
10k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
100k
1M
Figure 4-8. AMP03 CMRR vs. frequency.
70
50
60
100
1k
10k
100k
TA = 25C
VS = 15V
40
Figure 4-6. AD8210 CMRR vs. frequency and
temperature (common-mode voltage > 5 V).
The AMP03 is a monolithic, unity-gain, 3 MHz differential amplifier. Incorporating a matched thin-film
resistor network, the AMP03 features stable operation
over temperature without requiring expensive external
matched components. The AMP03 is a basic analog
building block for differential amplifier and instrumentation applications (Figure 4-7).
AMP03
–IN 2
+IN 3
25k6
25k6
25k6
25k6
5
SENSE
7
–VCC
6
OUTPUT
4
–VEE
1
REFERENCE
CLOSED-LOOP GAIN (dB)
FREQUENCY (Hz)
30
20
10
0
–10
–20
–30
100
1k
10k
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
1M
Figure 4-9. AMP03 closed-loop gain
vs. frequency.
Figure 4-7. AMP03 functional block diagram.
4-5
10M
Figure 4-10 shows the small signal pulse response of
the AMP03.
TA = 25C
VS = 15V
The uncommitted amplifier is a high open-loop gain,
low offset, low drift op amp, with its noninverting input
connected to the internal 10 kV resistor. Both inputs are
accessible to the user.
Careful layout design has resulted in exceptional
common-mode rejection at higher frequencies. The
inputs are connected to Pin 1 (+IN) and Pin 8 (–IN),
which are adjacent to the power pins, Pin 2 (–VS) and
Pin 7 (+VS). Because the power pins are at ac ground,
input impedance balance and, therefore, common-mode
rejection are preserved at higher frequencies.
100
90
0
50mV
7
Figure 4-10. AMP03 small signal pulse response.
–IN 8
The AD628 is a high common-mode voltage difference
amplifier, combined with a user-configurable output
amplifier (see Figure 4-11 and Figure 4-12). Differential
mode voltages in excess of 120 V are accurately scaled by
a precision 11:1 voltage divider at the input. A reference
voltage input is available to the user at Pin 3 (VREF).
The output common-mode voltage of the difference
amplifier is the same as the voltage applied to the reference pin. If the uncommitted amplifier is configured for
gain, connecting Pin 3 to one end of the external gain
resistor establishes the output common-mode voltage
at Pin 5 (OUT).
RG
8
100k6
10k6
–IN
–IN
G = +0.1
A2
10k6
A1
5
1
OUT
CFILT
+IN
A2
+IN 1
OUT
5
–IN
100k6
10k6
–VS
2
VREF
3
RG
6
REXT3
REFERENCE
VOLTAGE
REXT2
REXT1
Figure 4-12. AD628 circuit connections.
Gain Adjustment


R
GTOTAL = 0.1 × 1 + EXT 1 
 REXT 2 
10k6
VREF
10k6
A1
+IN
100k6
4
AD628
G = +0.1
+IN
3
4
10k6
–IN
+IN
+IN
100k6
The AD628 system gain is provided by an architecture
consisting of two amplifiers. The gain of the input stage
is fixed at 0.1; the output buffer is user-adjustable as
GA2 = 1 + REXT1/REXT2.
6
–IN
CFILT
+VS
1s
Figure 4-11. AD628 simplified schematic.
The output of the difference amplifier is internally
connected to a 10 kV resistor trimmed to better than
60.1% absolute accuracy. The resistor is connected
to the noninverting input of the output amplifier and
is accessible to the user at Pin 4 (CFILT). A capacitor
can be connected to implement a low-pass filter, a
resistor can be connected to further reduce the output
voltage, or a clamp circuit can be connected to limit
the output swing.
At 2 nA maximum, the input bias current of the buffer
amplifier is very low, and any offset voltage induced at
the buffer amplifier by its bias current may normally
be neglected (2 nA 3 10 kV = 20 mV). However, to
absolutely minimize bias current effects, REXT1 and
REXT2 can be selected so that their parallel combination is 10 kV. If practical resistor values force the
parallel combination of REXT1 and REXT2 below 10 kV,
a series resistor (REXT3) can be added to make up for
the difference. Table 4-2 lists several values of gain and
corresponding resistor values.
4-6
Table 4-2. Nearest Standard 1% Resistor Values
for Various Gains (See Figure 4-12)
A2 Gain
(V/V)
REXT1
(V)
REXT2
(V)
REXT3
(V)
0.1
0.2
0.25
0.5
1
2
5
10
1
2
2.5
5
10
20
50
100
10 k
20 k
25.9 k
49.9 k
100 k
200 k
499 k
1 M

20 k
18.7 k
12.4 k
11 k
10.5 k
10.2 k
10.2 k
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
50
30
1k
10k
100k
1M
10M
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 4-14. AD628 small signal frequency
response, VOUT = 200 mV p-p, G = +0.1, +1, +10,
and +100.
60
50
40

 × 1
G = +100
30
120
20
G = +10
10
0
G = +1
–10
110
–20
100
CMRR (dB)
G = +0.1
–40
100
130
VS = 15V
90
–40
10
70
40
100
1k
10k
1k
10k
100k
1M
Figure 4-15. AD628 large signal frequency
response, VOUT = 20 V p-p, G = +0.1, +1, +10,
and +100.
50
10
100
FREQUENCY (Hz)
VS = 2.5V
60
G = +0.1
–30
80
30
G = +1
0
–30
GAIN (dB)
EXT 4
10
–20
Using a divider and setting A2 to unity gain yields
GW / DIVIDER
G = +10
20
–10
To set the system gain to less than 0.1, an attenuator
can be created by placing a resistor, R EXT4 , from
Pin 4 (C FILT ) to the reference voltage. A divider
would be formed by the 10 kV resistor, which is in
series with the positive input of A2 and R EXT4 . A2
would be configured for unity gain.

REXT 4
= 0.1 × 
 10 kΩ + R
G = +100
40
GAIN (dB)
Total Gain
(V/V)
60
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 4-13. AD628 CMRR vs. frequency.
For extensive coverage of AD628 applications circuits,
refer to Chapter 6 of this guide.
The AD626 is a single- or dual-supply differential
amplifier consisting of a precision balanced attenuator,
a very low drift preamplifier (A1), and an output
buffer amplifier (A2). It has been designed so that
small differential signals can be accurately amplified
and filtered in the presence of large common-mode
voltages (much greater than the supply voltage) without
the use of any other active components.
4-7
+VS
+IN
R1
200k
FILTER
AD626
C1
5pF
R12
100k
A1
–IN
R2
200k
R3
41k
R11
10k
A2
C2
5pF
R6
500
R4
41k
R5
4.2k
R17
95k
R15
10k
R9
10k
R7
500
R10
10k
R8
10k
R14
555
GAIN = 100
GND
OUT
R13
10k
–VS
Figure 4-16. AD626 simplified schematic.
Figure 4-16 shows the main elements of the AD626.
The signal inputs at Pins 1 and 8 are first applied to dual
resistive attenuators, R1 through R4, whose purpose is
to reduce the peak common-mode voltage at the input
to the preamplifier—a feedback stage based on the very
low drift op amp A1. This allows the differential input
voltage to be accurately amplified in the presence of
large common-mode voltages—six times greater than
that which can be tolerated by the actual input to A1. As
a result, the input common-mode range extends to six
times the quantity (VS – 1 V).The overall common-mode
error is minimized by precise laser trimming of R3 and
R4, thus giving the AD626 a common-mode rejection
ratio of at least 10,000:1 (80 dB). The output of A1 is
connected to the input of A2 via 100 k (R12) resistor
to facilitate the low-pass filtering of the signal of interest.
The AD626 is easily configured for gains of 10 or 100. For
a gain of 10, Pin 7 is simply left unconnected; similarly,
for a gain of 100, Pin 7 is grounded. Gains between 10
and 100 are easily set by connecting a resistor between
Pin 7 and analog GND. Because the on-chip resistors
have an absolute tolerance of 20% (although they are
ratio matched to within 0.1%), at least a 20% adjustment
range must be provided. The nominal value for this gain
setting resistor is equal to
R=
 50, 000 Ω 
− 555 Ω
 GAIN − 10 
500mV
20s
100
90
10
0%
Figure 4-17. T
he large signal pulse
response of the AD626. G = 10.
Figure 4-17 shows the large signal pulse response of
the AD626.
The AD629 is a unity-gain difference amplifier designed
for applications that require the measurement of signals
with common-mode input voltages of up to 270 V.
The AD629 keeps error to a minimum by providing
excellent CMR in the presence of high common-mode
input voltages. Finally, it can operate from a wide power
supply range of 2.5 V to 18 V.
The AD629 can replace costly isolation amplifiers
in applications that do not require galvanic isolation. Figure 4-18 is the connection diagram of the
AD629. Figure 4-19 shows the AD629’s CMR vs.
frequency.
4-8
–IN
2
+IN 3
21.1k�
AD629
380k�
380k�
380k�
PD
8
7
20k�
VIN
+VS
6
OUTPUT
5
REF B
95
90
85
CMR (dB)
VOUT
6
REF
4
FB
5
2
Figure 4-20. AD8130 block diagram.
100
80
75
70
65
60
55
1k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
7
8
Figure 4-20 is a block diagram of the AD8130. Its design
uses an architecture called active feedback, which differs
from that of conventional op amps. The most obvious
differentiating feature is the presence of two separate
pairs of differential inputs compared to a conventional
op amp’s single pair. Typically for the active feedback
architecture, one of these input pairs is driven by a
differential input signal, while the other is used for the
feedback. This active stage in the feedback path is where
the term active feedback is derived. The active feedback
architecture offers several advantages over a conventional
op amp in several types of applications. Among these are
excellent common-mode rejection, wide input commonmode range, and a pair of inputs that are high impedance
and totally balanced in a typical application.
Figure 4-18. AD629 connection diagram.
100
1
–VS
NC = NO CONNECT
50
20
+VS
3
–
+
–VS 4
NC
10k
–30
20k
–40
Figure 4-19 AD629 common-mode rejection
vs. frequency.
High Frequency Differential Receiver/Amplifiers
Although not normally associated with difference amplifiers, the AD8130 series of very high speed differential
receiver/amplifiers represent a new class of products
that provide effective common-mode rejection at VHF
frequencies. The AD8130 has a –3 dB bandwidth of
270 MHz, an 80 dB CMR at 2 MHz, and a 70 dB CMR
at 10 MHz.
COMMON-MODE REJECTION (dB)
REF A 1
–50
–60
–70
–80
VS = 2.5V
–90
VS = 5V, 12V
–100
–110
–120
10k
100k
1M
FREQUENCY (Hz)
10M
Figure 4-21. AD8130 CMR vs. frequency.
4-9
100M
In addition, while an external feedback network
establishes the gain response as in a conventional
op amp, its separate path makes it totally independent of
the signal input. This eliminates any interaction between
the feedback and input circuits, which traditionally causes
problems with CMRR in conventional differential-input
op amp circuits.
3
2
VS = 2.5V
1
GAIN (dB)
0
–1
VS = 5V
–2
VS = 12V
–3
–4
–5
–6
–7
1
10
100
400
FREQUENCY (MHz)
Figure 4-22. AD8130 frequency response
vs. gain and supply voltage.
Figure 4-21 shows the CMR vs. frequency of the
AD8130. Figure 4-22 shows its gain vs. frequency for
various supply voltages.
4-10
Chapter V
APPLYING IN-AMPS EFFECTIVELY
Dual-Supply Operation
The conventional way to power an in-amp has been
from a split or dual polarity power supply. This has
the obvious advantage of allowing both a positive and
a negative input and output swing.
Single-Supply Operation
Single-supply operation has become an increasingly
desirable characteristic of a modern in-amp. Many
present day data acquisition systems are powered from
a single low voltage supply. For these systems, there
are two vitally important characteristics. First, the
in-amp’s input range should extend between the positive
supply and the negative supply (or ground). Second, the
amplifier’s output should be rail-to-rail as well.
The Need for True R-R Devices in Low Voltage,
Single-Supply IA Circuits
Sometimes problems arise when designers forget
about amplifier headroom and use standard (non
rail-to-rail) products in low voltage, single-supply
in-amp applications. Many dual-supply in-amps will
only have an output swing within about 2 V of either
rail. However, even the very best cannot swing as
close to the rails as a single-supply device.
In the example shown in Figure 5-1, the p-p output swing
would only be about 1 V p-p for a standard product vs.
4 V p-p or more for a rail-to-rail in-amp.
Power Supply Bypassing, Decoupling, and
Stability Issues
Power supply decoupling is an important detail that
is often overlooked by designers. Normally, bypass
capacitors (values of 0.1 F are typical) are connected
between the power supply pins of each IC and ground.
Although usually adequate, this practice can be ineffective
or even create worse transients than no bypassing at all.
It is important to consider where the circuit’s currents
originate, where they will return, and by what path. Once
that has been established, bypass these currents around
ground and other signal paths.
In general, like op amps, most monolithic in-amps have
their integrators referenced to one or both power supply
lines and should be decoupled with respect to the output
reference terminal.This means that for each chip, a bypass
capacitor should be connected between each power supply
pin and the point on the board where the in-amp’s reference
terminal is connected, as shown in Figure 5-2.
A good quality rail-to-rail in-amp, such as the AD623, can
swing its output to within 0.5 V of the supply and within
0.1 V above ground. Its input voltage range is similar.
Note that these numbers are conservative: with very light
output loading the performance is even better. So, when
using a 5 V single supply, the amplifier has at least a 4 V
output swing, in many cases, more than that.
+VS
).!-0
M&
M&
M&
M&
63
+VS
6/54
–IN
R-R
IN-AMP
VOUT
+VS
2
+IN
n63
GND
Figure 5-1. A modern rail-to-rail in-amp can
swing more than 4 V p-p with a 5 V supply, but
this is NOT possible using a standard dualsupply device. Note that the in-amp’s VREF pin
would normally be set at VS/2 for maximum
output swing.
Figure 5-2. Recommended method for
power supply bypassing.
For a much more comprehensive discussion of these
issues, refer to Application Note AN-202, An IC Amplifier User’s Guide to Decoupling, Grounding, and Making
Things Go Right for a Change, by Paul Brokaw, on the
ADI website at www.analog.com.
5-1
THE IMPORTANCE OF AN INPUT GROUND
RETURN
+VS
AC coupling is an easy way to block dc voltages that
are present at the in-amp’s inputs. But ac coupling into
a high impedance in-amp input without providing a dc
return renders the circuit nonfunctional! This is one of
the most common applications problems that arises when
using in-amp circuits. Figure 5-3 shows two common
(incorrect) arrangements.
R1
IB2
VOUT
IN-AMP
REFERENCE
INPUT
R2
–VS
VOS = (IB1 R1) – (IB1 R2)
Figure 5-4. A high value resistor between
each input and ground provides an effective
dc return path (see Table 5-1).
C1
–IN
IN-AMP
C2
+IN
+VS
C2
IB1
–IN
THESE CIRCUITS WILL NOT WORK!
A
C1
This is a simple and practical solution for dual-supply
in-amp circuits. The resistors allow a discharge path for
input bias currents. Now both inputs are referenced to
ground. There will be a small offset voltage error due to
the mismatch between the input bias currents flowing
through the two nonidentical resistors. To avoid errors
due to an R1/R2 mismatch, a third resistor, about onetenth their value, can be connected between the two
in-amp inputs.
VOUT
+IN
–VS
TRANSFORMER COUPLED
WITH NO DC RETURN
Figure 5-5 shows the recommended dc return for a
transformer-coupled input.
B
+VS
– INPUT
Figure 5-3. Nonfunctional, ac-coupled
in-amp circuits.
RG
In Figure 5-3A, the input bias currents will charge up
the ac coupling capacitors until the input common-mode
voltage is exceeded. In other words, the caps will charge
up to the supply line or down to ground depending
on the direction of the input bias currents. Now, with
a FET input device, and very large capacitors, it could
take several minutes before the in-amp is rendered inoperative. As a result, a casual lab test might not detect
this problem, so it’s very important to avoid it altogether.
Figure 5-3B shows a transformer-coupled input with no
center tap or other means for a dc return; so, the same
problem occurs.
IN-AMP
VOUT
LOAD
+ INPUT
–VS
REFERENCE
TO POWER
SUPPLY
GROUND
Figure 5-5. Recommended dc return path
for a transformer-coupled input.
For transformers without a center tap, two resistors, one
from each input pin to ground, can be used to provide
a dc return path.
A simple solution for the circuit in Figure 5-3A is to add
a high value resistance (R1, R2) between each input and
ground, as shown in Figure 5-4. The input bias currents
can now flow freely to ground and do not build up a large
input offset as before.
5-2
Providing Adequate Input and Output Swing
(“Headroom”) When AC Coupling a Single-Supply
In-Amp
AC coupling using an in-amp powered by a single
supply is more complicated than dual-supply operation
and normally requires applying a dc common-mode
voltage, VCM, to both inputs, as shown in Figure 5-6.
This is necessary because the internal buffer amplifiers
of a typical 3-op amp in-amp cannot swing more than
a few millivolts below the negative supply (in this case
ground) without clipping the signal. In addition, the
output can never swing below the negative supply.
63
6##
).
2
).!-0
Output centering is similar: estimate the amount and the
direction of the in-amp’s output swing (in most cases this
will be VIN 3 gain + VREF) and then apply a reference
voltage at VREF that is in the center of that range.
Selecting and Matching RC Coupling Components
In ac-coupled applications, selecting values for the
capacitors and dc return resistors is a trade-off between
–3 dB bandwidth, noise, input bias current, and the
physical size of the capacitors. RC components should be
reasonably matched so that the time constant of R1/C1
is close to that of R2, C2. Otherwise, a common-mode
voltage can be converted into a differential error.
#
n).
+2 V (or a bit higher), which will allow 2 V of headroom
in the minus direction. The trade-off is that there is now
2 V less swing in the positive direction. If the in-amp is
operating with gain, VCM needs to be tailored to allow
the buffer outputs to swing fully without clipping (that
is, without exceeding their maximum voltage swing in
either direction).
6/54
2
2%&%2%.#%
).054
Higher value input capacitors provide greater low
frequency bandwidths and allow smaller value input
resistors. But these caps are physically larger, requiring more board space. As a rule, capacitors larger
than 0.1 microFarad need to be polarized types such as
tantalums to keep their size manageable. But polarized
caps require a known, constant polarity dc voltage to
keep them properly biased.
62%&
490)#!,,963
Figure 5-6. An ac-coupled, single-supply,
in-amp circuit. For maximum dynamic range,
set VCM to the center of the maximum input
range. VREF is typically set to VS/2.
Choosing appropriate voltages for VCM and VREF is an
important design consideration, especially in low supply
voltage applications. In general terms, VCM should be
set to the middle of the expected input dynamic range,
while VREF should be centered on the expected output
dynamic rage. As an example, say the input signal
(the difference between +IN and –IN) is expected to
be between +1 V and –2 V. Under these conditions,
the in-amp’s input buffers will need to swing both
positive and negative with respect to ground. Assume
the in-amp is operating at unity gain, VCM can be set to
Smaller cap values require higher value input resistors
which have higher noise. And with larger input resistors,
dc offset voltage errors also become larger. So, there is
always a trade-off that needs to be made here.
Since (IB1R1) – (IB2R2) = DVOS, any mismatch between
R1 and R2 will cause an input offset imbalance
(I B1 – IB2). The input bias currents of Analog Devices
in-amps vary widely, depending on input architecture.
However, the vast majority have maximum input bias
currents between 1.5 nA and 10 nA. A good guideline
is to keep IBR < 10 mV.
5-3
Table 5-1. Recommended Component Values
for AC Coupling In-Amp Inputs
Input Bias VOS
RC Coupling Components Current
at Each
–3 dB BW C1, C2
R1, R2
(IB)
Input
2 Hz
2 Hz
30 Hz
30 Hz
100 Hz
100 Hz
500 Hz
500 Hz
1 M
1 M
115 k
53.6 k
162 k
162 k
162 k
162 k
0.1 F
0.1 F
0.047 F
0.1 F
0.01 F
0.01 F
0.002 F
0.002 F
2 nA
10 nA
2 nA
10 nA
2 nA
10 nA
2 nA
10 nA
Table 5-1 gives typical R and C cookbook values for ac
coupling using 1% metal film resistors and two values
of input bias current.
Properly Driving an In-Amp’s Reference Input
Another common applications problem occurs when
a high impedance source is used to drive an in-amp’s
reference terminal. In the example shown in Figure 5-7,
R2’s added resistance unbalances the otherwise closely
matched resistors in subtractor amplifier A3. A resistor
divider is shown here, but the same problem is created
with any input source that is even a small percentage of
RREF. This results in both a CMR error and a reference
voltage error.
REFERENCE
INPUT
R1
R2
–
IN-AMP
EXTERNAL
REFERENCE
VOLTAGE
OP AMP
BUFFER
RREF
EXTERNAL
VOLTAGE
DIVIDER
+
SUBTRACTOR
A1
Figure 5-8. A simple op amp buffer provides a
low impedance for driving an in-amp’s input.
2
A3
VOUT
6
3
VIN+
40 V
200 V
5 V
11 V
7 V
32 V
7 V
32 V
A CMR error is introduced because RREF2 no longer
equals RREF1 (R2 is in series). Note that RREF1 and RREF2
are not always equal but that introducing any significant
series resistance between the VREF terminal and ground
will unbalance A3 and cause a CMR error. A reference
voltage error is also produced because R2 becomes
loaded by the in-amp’s finite reference impedance.
IN-AMP
VIN–
2 mV
10 mV
230 V
536 V
324 V
1.6 mV
324 V
1.6 mV
VOS Error
for 2%
R1, R2 Mismatch
A2
RREF1 RREF2
REFERENCE
INPUT
PROBLEM: R2’s RESISTANCE
CAUSES CMR ERROR AND RREF1
AND RREF2 ARE NOW UNBALANCED.
AN ADDITIONAL VOLTAGE
REFERENCE ERROR IS INTRODUCED
BY THE SHUNTING OF R2 BY RREF1
AND RREF2.
EXTERNAL
VOLTAGE
DIVIDER
R1
R2
EXTERNAL
REFERENCE
VOLTAGE
Figure 5-8 shows a simple solution to this problem.
An op amp buffer is added between the voltage divider
(or other high-Z source) and the in-amp’s reference
terminal. Now, the in-amp only sees the very low
output impedance of the op amp, which typically is
much less than one ohm.
Many other solutions are possible, as long as the impedance driving the reference terminal is kept very low.
Figure 5-7. When using this simple voltage
divider, RREF1 and RREF2 are now unbalanced,
which introduces a large CMR error in A3.
5-4
Cable Termination
When in-amps are used at frequencies above a few hundred kilohertz, properly terminated 50  or 75  coaxial
cable should be used for input and output connections.
Normally, cable termination is simply a 50  or 75 
resistor connected between the cable center conductor,
and its shield is at the end of the coaxial cable. Note that
a buffer amplifier may be required to drive these loads
to useful levels.
Figure 5-9 provides details on the input architecture
of the AD8221 in-amp. As shown, they have internal
400  resistors that are in series with each input
transistor junction.
+VS
–IN
Input Protection Basics
For ADI In-Amps
Input Protection from ESD and DC Overload
As interface amplifiers for data acquisition systems,
instrumentation amplifiers are often subjected to input
overloads, i.e., voltage levels in excess of their full scale
for the selected gain range or even in excess of the supply
voltage. These overloads fall into two general classes:
steady state and transient (ESD, etc.), both of which
occur for only a fraction of a second. With 3-op amp
in-amp designs, when operating at low gains (10 or
less), the gain resistor acts as a current-limiting element
in series with their resistor inputs. At high gains, the
lower value of RG may not adequately protect the
inputs from excessive currents.
Standard practice is to place current-limiting resistors
in each input, but adding this protection also increases
the circuit’s noise level. A reasonable balance needs to be
found between the protection provided and the increased
resistor (Johnson) noise introduced. Circuits using
in-amps with a relatively high noise level can tolerate
more series protection without seriously increasing
their total circuit noise.
+VS
400
Q1
400
Q2
RG
–VS
+IN
–VS
6mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
Figure 5-9. AD8221 in-amp input circuit.
The AD8221 was designed to handle maximum
input currents of 6 mA steady state (or dc), at room
temperature. Its internal resistors and diodes will
protect the device from input voltages 0.7 V above
the positive supply, or 2.4 V more negative than
the minus supply (6 mA  0.4 k). Therefore, for
15 V supplies, the maximum safe input level is
+15.7 V, –17.4 V. Additional external series resistors
can be added to increase this level considerably, at the
expense of a higher circuit noise level.
The AD8221 in-amp is a very low noise device, with a
maximum (eNI ) 8 nV/√Hz. A single 1 k resistor will
add approximately 4 nV/√Hz of Johnson noise. The
addition of this resistor would raise the maximum
dc level to approximately 22.5 V above each supply or
37.5 V with 15 V supplies.
Of course, the less added noise the better, but a good
guideline is that circuits needing this extra protection
can easily tolerate resistor values that generate 30% of
the total circuit noise. For example, a circuit using an
in-amp with a rated noise level of 20 nV/√Hz can tolerate
an additional 6 nV/√Hz of Johnson noise.
Use the following cookbook method to translate this
number into a practical resistance value. The Johnson
noise of a 1 k resistor is approximately 4 nV/√Hz. This
value varies as the square root of the resistance. So,
a 20 k resistor would have √20 times as much noise
as the 1 k resistor, which is 17.88 nV/√Hz (4.4721 3
4 nV/√Hz). Because both inputs need to be protected,
two resistors are needed, and their combined noise will
add as the square root of the number of resistors (the
root sum of squares value). In this case, the total added
noise from the two 20 k resistors will be 25.3 nV/√Hz
(17.88 3 1.414).
+VS
+VS
+VS
+VS
+VS
–IN
4006
–VS
+VS
Q1
4006
Q2
RG
+IN
–VS
6mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
Figure 5-10. AD8222 and AD8225 in-amp
input circuit.
The AD8222 and AD8225 have a very similar input
section to that of the AD8221. Except that now, all six
diodes are located on the Q1/Q2 side of the 400  input
resistor (see Figure 5-10).
5-5
Figure 5-11 shows the input section of the AD620 series
(AD620, AD621, and AD622) in-amps. This is very
similar to that of the AD8221: Both use a 400  resistor
in series with each input, and both use diode protection.
The chief differences are the four additional AD8221
diodes. One set is tied between each input and the
positive supply, and the other set is connected between
the base of each input transistor and the negative supply.
The AD620 uses its 400  internal resistor and a single
set of diodes to protect against negative input voltages.
For positive voltage overloads, it relies on its own baseemitter input junction to act as the clamping diode.
+VS
case, adding two 5 k resistors will raise the circuit’s
noise approximately 13 nV/√Hz (30 percent) but would
provide an additional 100 V of transient overload
protection.
Figure 5-13 shows the input architecture of the AD623
in-amp. In this design, the internal (ESD) diodes are
located before the input resistors and, as a consequence,
provide less protection than the designs previously
discussed. The AD623 can tolerate 10 mA maximum
input current, but in many cases, some external series
resistance will be needed to keep input current below
this level.
+VS
+VS
+VS
400�
–IN
Q1
400�
Q2
1k
–IN
+IN
RG
–VS
6mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
+VS
–IN
2k
Q2
–VS
–VS
–VS
–VS
Figure 5-14 shows the simplified input circuitry for the
AD8230 zero-drift in-amp. As shown, the AD8230 only
has a single ESD diode connected between each input
and the negative supply line. This diode offers ESD
protection for negative pulses larger than 0.7 below the
negative supply. However, it was not designed to protect
the in-amp against positive voltage transients or long
duration voltage overloads in either direction.To protect
against these, external low leakage diodes and resistors
are needed, as shown in Figure 5-20.
+IN
200k
–VS
+IN
Figure 5-13. AD623 in-amp input circuit.
+VS
Q1
1k
Since the AD623’s device noise is approximately
35 nV/√Hz, up to 5 k of external resistance can be
added here to provide 50 V of dc overload protection,
while only increasing input noise to 38 nV/√Hz total.
+VS
2k
–VS
Q2
+VS
10mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
Figure 5-11. AD620 series (AD620, AD621,
and AD622) in-amp input circuit.
+VS
Q1
+VS
–VS
6mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
Figure 5-12. AD627 in-amp input circuit.
The AD627 can tolerate 20 mA transient input currents
(Figure 5-12). In addition, it has built-in 2 k resistors
and can handle input voltages 40 volts higher than its
supply lines (20 mA 3 2 k). This level of protection
is quite beneficial. Because of its low power, many of
the AD627’s applications will use a low voltage single
power supply. If even more protection is needed, quite
large external resistors can be added without seriously
degrading the AD627’s 38 nV/√Hz noise level. In this
5-6
–IN
1606
G
+IN
1606
D
D
Q1
Q2
S
G
S
–VS
–VS
6mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
Figure 5-14. AD8230 in-amp input circuit.
Figure 5-15 is a simplified diagram showing the input
structure for the AD8220 JFET in-amp.The input circuit
has a very high impedance: typically 1000 GV and 6 pF.
There are two ESD protection diodes at each input but
no internal series resistance between the input terminals
and the JFET input stage. Therefore, external resistors
need to be added to limit the current in applications
subject to an input overvoltage condition.
+VS
VCC
VCC
–IN
VCC
1906
M1
1906
M2
+IN
+VS
+VS
+VS
5mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
Figure 5-17. AD8553 in-amp simplified input circuit.
+IN
–IN
–VS
Figure 5-17 shows the input section of the AD8553
zero drift in-amp. This has a 190 V internal protection
resistor between each input pin and the diode clamping
circuitry.
–VS
The maximum input current of the AD8553 is approximately 5 mA, so additional external resistance may be
needed in some applications (see table 5-2).
5mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
Figure 5-15. AD8220 in-amp input circuit.
Figure 5-16 shows a simplified version of the AD8250
input circuitry. Here, two internal resistors and two diodes
protect each input. The AD8250 can tolerate maximum
sustained input currents of 20 mA. Note that there are
two pairs of input protection resistors—one between each
input and the two ESD diodes, and the other between
these diodes and the transistor base. This offers more
protection to the transistor bases than to the ESD diodes.
Therefore, designers should take precautions to protect
the ESD diodes from being destroyed.
Also note that when the input voltage approaches
VCC – 0.2 V (outside the input common-mode range),
current will begin to f low into the inputs of the
AD8553. If the enable pin is also held low during
this period of time, the output of the AD8553 will
no longer be high impedance. In some applications,
multiple AD8553 instrumentation amplifier outputs
can be connected together to mux many inputs to
one output. In these applications, only one AD8553
enable pin will be high, while all of the other AD8553
enable pins will be low.
+VS
+VS
+VS
–IN
2006
+VS
1006
–VS
1006
20mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
2006
–VS
Figure 5-16. AD8250 in-amp input circuit.
5-7
+IN
If an input overload voltage of VCC – 0.2 V or greater
occurs on any of the AD8553 instrumentation amplifier
inputs while its enable pin is low, the output of that
amplifier can overload the AD8553 that is driving the
output (enable pin is high).
The AD8555 and AD8556 products are instrumentation
amplifiers designed to be used in sensor applications.
Figure 5-18 is a simplified input circuit for the AD8555.
Here, protection diodes are connected between each
input terminal and the supplies. The input signal then
travels through a series resistor before arriving at the
amplification and switching circuitry.
+VS
+VS
+VS
3886
–IN
–VS
3886
5mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
+IN
–VS
Table 5-2. Recommended Series
Protection Resistor Values
Max
In-Amp
Input
Noise
Overload
Current
Device (eNI)
Recommended
External Protection
Resistors Adding
Additional Noise*
of 10%
of 40%
AD8220
AD8221
AD8222
AD8225
AD8230
AD8250
AD8251
AD8553
AD8555
AD8556
AD620
AD621
AD622
AD623
AD627
1.74 k
500 
500 
500 
4.99 k
1.30 k
1.30 k
6.98 k
8.06 k
8.06 k
634 
634 
634 
9.53 k
11.3 k
15 nV/√Hz
8 nV/√Hz
8 nV/√Hz
8 nV/√Hz
160 nV/√Hz
13 nV/√Hz
13 nV/√Hz
30 nV/√Hz
32 nV/√Hz
32 nV/√Hz
9 nV/√Hz
9 nV/√Hz
9 nV/√Hz
35 nV/√Hz
38 nV/√Hz
5 mA
6 mA
6 mA
6 mA
6 mA
20 mA
20 mA
5 mA
5 mA
5 mA
6 mA
6 mA
6 mA
10 mA
20 mA
*This noise level is for two resistors, one in series with
each input.
Figure 5-18. AD8555 in-amp simplified input circuit.
The AD8556 input circuitry (Figure 5-19) is very similar
to that of the AD8555, except that there is a larger value
resistor (3.6 kV) and other components between the
diode and the amplifying and switching circuitry. These
provide an internal RFI/EMI filtering capability.
Because the input circuitry in both products lacks an
internal resistor, before the first set of clamping diodes,
some external resistance is usually necessary to ensure
adequate overvoltage protection.
Table 5-2 provides recommended series protection resistor values for a 10% or 40% increase in circuit noise.
Adding External Protection Diodes
Device input protection may be increased with the
addition of external clamping diodes as shown in
Figure 5-20. As high current diodes are used, input
protection is increased, which allows the use of much
lower resistance input protection resistors that, in turn,
reduces the circuit’s noise.
Unfortunately, most ordinary diodes (Schottky, silicon,
etc.) have high leakage currents that will cause large offset
errors at the in-amp’s output; this leakage increases
exponentially with temperature. This tends to rule out
the use of external diodes in applications where the
in-amp is used with high impedance sources.
+VS
+VS
+VS
3.6k6
–IN
3.6k6
–VS
+IN
–VS
13pF
–VS
6.98 k
2.0 k
2.0 k
2.0 k
4.99 k
5.23 k
5.23 k
28.0 k
32.4 k
32.4 k
2.55 k
2.55 k
2.55 k
38.3 k
45.3 k
5pF
13pF
–VS
5mA MAX INPUT CURRENT
Figure 5-19. AD8556 simplified input circuit.
5-8
Specialty diodes with much lower leakage are available,
but these are often difficult to find and are expensive.
For the vast majority of applications, limiting resistors
alone provide adequate protection for ESD and longer
duration input transients.
+VS
+VS
–IN
D2
–VS
+IN
0.33MF
D1
RLIM
D3
RLIM
RG
0.01MF
IN-AMP
Although it is a simple matter to use a higher power protection resistor, this is a dangerous practice, as the power
dissipation will also increase in the in-amp’s input stage.
This can easily lead to device failure (see the preceding
section on input protection basics for input current
limitations of ADI in-amps). Except for ESD events, it
is always best to adopt a conservative approach and treat
all transient input signals as full duration inputs.
VOUT
D4
+VS
input resistors or the in-amps input stage. A 1 k resistor,
in series with an in-amp input terminal drawing
20 mA, will dissipate 0.4 W, which can easily be handled
by a standard 0.5 W or greater surface-mount resistor.
If the input current is doubled, power consumption
quadruples as it increases as the square of the input
current (or as the square of the applied voltage).
0.33MF –V 0.01MF
S
D1–D4 ARE INTERNATIONAL RECTIFIER SD101 SERIES
FAST SCHOTTKY BARRIER RECTIFIERS
Figure 5-20. Using external components
to increase input protection.
Despite their limitations, external diodes are often
required in some special applications, such as electric
shock defibrillators, which utilize short duration, high
voltage pulses. The combination of external diodes and
very large input resistors (as high as 100 k) may be
needed to adequately protect the in-amp.
It is a good idea to check the diodes’ specifications to
ensure that their conduction begins well before the
in-amp’s internal protection diodes start drawing current. Although they provide excellent input protection,
standard Schottky diodes can have leakage up to several
mA. However, as in the example of Figure 5-20, fast
Schottky barrier rectifiers, such as the international
rectifier type SD101 series, can be used; these devices
have 200 nA max leakage currents and 400 mW typical
power dissipation.
ESD and Transient Overload Protection
Protecting in-amp inputs from high voltage transients and
ESD events is very important for a circuit’s long-term
reliability. Power dissipation is often a critical factor,
as input resistors, whether internal or external, must
be able to handle most of the power of the input pulse
without failing.
ESD events, while they may be very high voltage, are
usually of very short duration and are normally one-time
events. Since the circuit has plenty of time to cool down
before the next event occurs, modest input protection is
sufficient to protect the device from damage.
On the other hand, regularly occurring short duration
input transients can easily overheat and burn out the
Designs that are expected to survive such events over long
periods of time must use resistors with enough resistance
to protect the in-amp’s input circuitry from failure and
enough power to prevent resistor burnout.
Design Issues Affecting DC Accuracy
The modern in-amp is continually being improved,
providing the user with ever increasing accuracy and
versatility at a lower price. Despite these improvements
in product performance, there remain some fundamental
applications issues that seriously affect device accuracy.
Now that low cost, high resolution ADCs are commonly
used, system designers need to ensure that if an in-amp is
used as a preamplifier ahead of the converter, the in-amp’s
accuracy matches that of the ADC.
Designing for the Lowest Possible Offset
Voltage Drift
Offset drift errors include not just those associated with
the active device being used (IC in-amp or discrete in-amp
design using op amps), but also thermocouple effects in
the circuit’s components or wiring. The in-amp’s input
bias and input offset currents flowing through unbalanced
source impedances also create additional offset errors. In
discrete op amp in-amp designs, these errors can increase
with temperature unless precision op amps are used.
Designing for the Lowest Possible Gain Drift
When planning for gain errors, the effects of board layout,
the circuit’s thermal gradients, and the characteristics of
any external gain setting resistors are often overlooked. A
gain resistor’s absolute tolerance, its thermal temperature
coefficient, its physical position relative to other resistors in the same gain network, and even its physical
orientation (vertical or horizontal) are all-important
design considerations if high dc accuracy is needed.
5-9
In many ADC preamp circuits, an external user-selected
resistor sets the gain of the in-amp, so the absolute
tolerance of this resistor and its variation over temperature, compared to that of the IC’s on-chip resistors, will
affect the circuit’s gain accuracy. Resistors commonly
used include through-hole 1% 1/4 W metal film types
and 1% 1/8 W chip resistors. Both types typically have
a 100 ppm/°C temperature coefficient. However, some
chip resistors can have TCs of 200 ppm/C or even
250 ppm/C.
Even when a 1% 100 ppm/C resistor is used, the gain
accuracy of the in-amp will be degraded. The resistor’s
initial room temperature accuracy is only 1%, and
the resistor will drift another 0.01% (100 ppm/C) for
every C change in temperature. The initial gain error
can easily be subtracted out in software, but to correct
for the error vs. temperature, frequent recalibrations (and
a temperature sensor) would be required.
If the circuit is calibrated initially, the overall gain accuracy
is reduced to approximately 10 bits (0.1%) accuracy for
a 10C change. An in-amp with a standard 1% metal film
gain resistor should never be used ahead of even a 12-bit
converter: It would destroy the accuracy of a 14-bit or
16-bit converter.
Additional error sources associated with external resistors
also affect gain accuracy. The first are variations in resistor
heating caused by input signal level. Figure 5-21, a simple
op amp voltage amplifier, provides a practical example.
R1 = 100
G = 1 + ——
R2
R1 = 9.9k�, 1/4W
R2 = 1k�, 1/4W
Figure 5-21. An example of how differences in
input signal level can introduce gain errors.
Under zero signal conditions, there is no output signal
and no resistor heating. When an input signal is applied,
however, an amplified voltage appears at the op amp
output. When the amplifier is operating with gain,
Resistor R1 will be greater than R2. This means that
there will be more voltage across R1 than across R2.
The power dissipated in each resistor equals the square
of the voltage across it divided by its resistance in ohms.
The power dissipated and, therefore, the internal heating
of the resistor will increase in proportion to the value of
the resistor.
In the example, R1 is 9.9 k and R2 is 1 k. Consequently,
R1 will dissipate 9.9 times more power than R2. This
leads to a gain error that will vary with input level. The
use of resistors with different temperature coefficients
can also introduce gain errors.
A1
R3
10k�
R4
10k�
SENSE
R1
25k�
RG
A3
OUTPUT
R2
25k�
A2
R5
10k�
R6
10k�
REF
Figure 5-22. A typical discrete 3-op amp in-amp
using large value, low TC feedback resistors.
Even when resistors with matched temperature coefficients (TC) are used, gain errors that vary with input
signal level can still occur. The use of larger (i.e., higher
power) resistors will reduce these effects, but accurate,
low TC power resistors are expensive and hard to find.
When a discrete 3-op amp in-amp is used, as shown
in Figure 5-22, these errors will be reduced. In a
3-op amp in-amp, there are two feedback resistors, R1
and R2, and one gain resistor, RG. Since the in-amp uses
two feedback resistors while the op amp uses only one,
each of the in-amp’s resistors only needs to dissipate half
the power (for the same gain). Monolithic in-amps, such
as the AD620, offer a further advantage by using relatively
large value (25 k) feedback resistors. For a given gain
and output voltage, large feedback resistors will dissipate
less power (i.e., P = V2/RF). Of course, a discrete in-amp
can be designed to use large value, low TC resistors as
well, but with added cost and complexity.
Another less serious but still significant error source
is the so-called thermocouple effect, sometimes
referred to as thermal EMF. This occurs when two
different conductors, such as copper and metal film,
are tied together. When this bimetallic junction is
heated, a simple thermocouple is created. When using
similar metals, such as a copper-to-copper junction,
a thermoelectric error voltage of up to 0.2 mV/C may
be produced. An example of these effects is shown in
Figure 5-23.
5-10
A final error source occurs when there is a thermal
gradient across the external gain resistor. Something as
simple as mounting a resistor on end to conserve board
space will invariably produce a temperature gradient
across the resistor. Placing the resistor flat down against
the PC board will cure this problem unless there is air
flowing along the axis of the resistor (where the air flow
cools one side of the resistor more than the other side).
Orienting the resistor so that its axis is perpendicular to
the airflow will minimize this effect.
RESISTOR
MATERIAL
T1
Option 2: Use a Fixed-Gain In-Amp
By far, the best overall dc performance is provided
by using a monolithic in-amp, such as the AD621 or
AD8225, in which all the resistors are contained within
the IC. Now all resistors have identical TCs, all are at
virtually the same temperature. Any thermal gradients
across the chip are very small, and gain error drift is
guaranteed and specified to very high standards.
At a gain of 10, the AD621 has a guaranteed maximum
dc offset shift of less than 2.5 µV/C and a maximum gain
drift of 5 ppm/°C, which is only 0.0005%/C.
The AD8225 is an in-amp with a fixed gain of 5. It has
a maximum offset shift of 2 V/C and a maximum drift
of 0.3 V/C.
T2
RTI AND RTO ERRORS
Another important design consideration is how circuit
gain affects many in-amp error sources such as dc offset
and noise. An in-amp should be regarded as a two stage
amplifier with both an input and an output section. Each
section has its own error sources.
RESISTOR LEADS
TYPICAL RESISTOR THERMOCOUPLE EMFs
• CARBON COMPOSITION
400�V/�C
• METAL FILM
20�V/�C
• EVENOHM OR MANGANIN
WIRE-WOUND
2�V/�C
• RCD COMPONENTS HP-SERIES 0.05�V/�C
Figure 5-23. Thermocouple effects inside
discrete resistors.
Practical Solutions
As outlined, a number of dc offset and gain errors are
introduced when external resistors are used with a
monolithic in-amp. Discrete designs tend to have even
larger errors. There are three practical solutions to this
problem: use higher quality resistors, use software correction, or, better still, use an in-amp that has all of its
gain resistors on-chip, such as the AD621.
Option 1: Use a Better Quality Gain Resistor
As a general rule, only 12-bit or 13-bit gain performance
is possible using commonly available 1% resistors,
which assumes that some type of initial calibration is
performed.
A practical solution to this problem is to simply use a
better quality resistor. A significant improvement can be
made using a 0.1%, 1/10 W, surface-mount resistor. Aside
from having a 10 better initial accuracy, it typically has
a TC of only 25 ppm/C, which will provide better than
13-bit accuracy over a 10C temperature range.
If even better gain accuracy is needed, there are specialty
houses that sell resistors with lower TCs, but these are
usually expensive military varieties.
Because the errors of the output section are multiplied
by a fixed gain (usually 2), this section is often the
principal error source at low circuit gains. When the
in-amp is operating at higher gains, the gain of the
input stage is increased. As the gain is raised, errors
contributed by the input section are multiplied, while
output errors are not. So, at high gains, the input stage
errors dominate.
Since device specifications on different data sheets often
refer to different types of errors, it is very easy for the
unwary designer to make an inaccurate comparison
between products. Any (or several) of four basic error
categories may be listed: input errors, output errors, total
error RTI, and total error RTO. Here follows an attempt
to list, and hopefully simplify, an otherwise complicated
set of definitions.
Input errors are those contributed by the amplifier’s input
stage alone; output errors are those due to the output
section. Input related specifications are often combined
and classified together as a referred to input (RTI) error,
while all output related specifications are considered
referred to output (RTO) errors.
For a given gain, an in-amp’s input and output errors
can be calculated using the following formulas:
Total Error, RTI = Input Error + (Output Error/Gain)
Total Error, RTO = (Gain  Input Error) + Output Error
Sometimes the specifications page will list an error term
as RTI or RTO for a specified gain. In other cases, it is up
to the user to calculate the error for the desired gain.
5-11
Offset Error
Using the AD620A as an example, the total voltage
offset error of this in-amp when operating at a gain of
10 can be calculated using the individual errors listed on
its specifications page. The (typical) input offset of the
AD620 (VOSI) is listed as 30 V. Its output offset (VOSO)
is listed as 400 V. Thus, the total voltage offset referred
to input (RTI) is equal to
Total RTI Error = VOSI + (VOSO/G) = 30 V + (400 V/10)
= 30 V + 40 V = 70 V
The total voltage offset referred to the output (RTO)
is equal to
Total Offset Error RTO = (G (VOSI )) +VOSO = (10 (30 V))
+ 400 V = 700 V
Note that the two error numbers (RTI vs. RTO) are
different: the RTO numbers are 103 larger, and
logically they should be, as at a gain of 10, the error at
the output of the in-amp should be 10 times the error
at its input.
Noise Errors
In-amp noise errors also need to be considered in a
similar way. Since the output section of a typical 3-op
amp in-amp operates at unity gain, the noise contribution
from the output stage is usually very small. But there
are 3-op amp in-amps that operate the output stage at
higher gains, and 2-op amp in-amps regularly operate the
second amplifier at gain. When either section is operated
at gain, its noise is amplified along with the input signal.
Both RTI and RTO noise errors are calculated the same
way as offset errors, except that the noise of two sections
adds as the root mean square. That is,
Input Noise = eni ,Output Noise = eno
Total Noise RTI =
Total Noise RTO =
(eni ) + (eno Gain )
2
2
Reducing RFI Rectification Errors in
In-Amp Circuits
Real-world applications must deal with an ever
increasing amount of radio frequency interference
(RFI). Of particular concern are situations in which
signal transmission lines are long and signal strength is
low. This is the classic application for an in-amp, since
its inherent common-mode rejection allows the device
to extract weak differential signals riding on strong
common-mode noise and interference.
One potential problem that is frequently overlooked,
however, is that of radio frequency rectification inside
the in-amp. When strong RF interference is present, it
may become rectified by the IC and then appear as a dc
output offset error. Common-mode signals present at
an in-amp’s input are normally greatly reduced by the
amplifier’s common-mode rejection.
Unfortunately, RF rectification occurs because even the
best in-amps have virtually no common-mode rejection at frequencies above 20 kHz. A strong RF signal
may become rectified by the amplifier’s input stage
and then appear as a dc offset error. Once rectified,
no amount of low-pass filtering at the in-amp output
will remove the error. If the RF interference is of an
intermittent nature, this can lead to measurement
errors that go undetected.
Designing Practical RFI Filters
The best practical solution is to provide RF attenuation
ahead of the in-amp by using a differential low-pass
filter.The filter needs to do three things: remove as much
RF energy from the input lines as possible, preserve
the ac signal balance between each line and ground
(common), and maintain a high enough input impedance over the measurement bandwidth to avoid loading
the signal source.
(Gain (eni )) + (eno )
2
2
For example, the (typical) noise of the AD620A
is specified as 9 nV/√Hz eni and 72 nV/√Hz eno.
Therefore, the total RTI noise of the AD620A operating
at a gain of 10 is equal to
Total Noise RTI =
(eni)2 + (eno Gain)2 =
(9)2 + (72 10)2 = 11.5 nV Hz
5-12
Figure 5-24 provides a basic building block for a wide
number of differential RFI filters. Component values
shown were selected for the AD8221, which has a typical
–3 dB bandwidth of 1 MHz and a typical voltage noise
level of 7 nV/√Hz. This same filter is recommended for
the AD8222 dual in-amp and for the AD8220 JFET
input in-amp. In addition to RFI suppression, the filter
provides additional input overload protection, as resistors
R1a and R1b help isolate the in-amp’s input circuitry
from the external signal source.
Figure 5-25 is a simplified version of the RFI circuit. It
reveals that the filter forms a bridge circuit whose output
appears across the in-amp’s input pins. Because of this,
any mismatch between the time constants of C1a/R1a
and C1b/R1b will unbalance the bridge and reduce high
frequency common-mode rejection. Therefore, resistors R1a and R1b and capacitors C1a and C1b should
always be equal.
As shown, C2 is connected across the bridge output
so that C2 is effectively in parallel with the series
combination of C1a and C1b. Thus connected, C2
very effectively reduces any ac CMR errors due to
mismatching. For example, if C2 is made 10 times
larger than C1, this provides a 20 reduction in CMR
errors due to C1a/C1b mismatch. Note that the filter
does not affect dc CMR.
The RFI filter has two different bandwidths: differential
and common mode. The differential bandwidth defines
the frequency response of the filter with a differential input
signal applied between the circuit’s two inputs, +IN and
–IN. This RC time constant is established by the sum of
the two equal-value input resistors (R1a, R1b), together
with the differential capacitance, which is C2 in parallel
with the series combination of C1a and C1b.
RFI FILTER
–IN
R1a
4.02k
0.01F
C1a
1000pF
1
–
2
C2
0.01F
+IN
3
4
C1b
1000pF
0.33F
8
G = 1+
AD8220
AD8221
AD8222
RG
R1b
4.02k
+VS
+
5
0.01F
49.4k
RG
7 15*
VOUT
6
REF
0.33F
*AD8222 ONLY
–VS
Figure 5-24. LP filter circuit used to prevent RFI rectification errors in AD8220, AD8221, and AD8222 in-amps.
R1a
C1a
+IN
IN-AMP
C2
VOUT
–IN
R1b
C1b
Figure 5-25. Capacitor C2 shunts C1a/C1b and very effectively reduces ac CMR errors due to
component mismatching.
5-13
The –3 dB differential bandwidth of this filter is
equal to
BWDIFF =
1
2πR(2C 2 + C 1)
The common-mode bandwidth defines what a
common-mode RF signal sees between the two inputs
tied together and ground. It’s important to realize that
C2 does not affect the bandwidth of the common-mode
RF signal, as this capacitor is connected between the
two inputs (helping to keep them at the same RF signal
level).Therefore, common-mode bandwidth is set by the
parallel impedance of the two RC networks (R1a/C1a
and R1b/C1b) to ground.
The –3 dB common-mode bandwidth is equal to
BWCM =
1
2πR1C 1
Using the circuit of Figure 5-24, with a C2 value of
0.01 F as shown, the –3 dB differential signal bandwidth
is approximately 1900 Hz. When operating at a gain of
5, the circuit’s measured dc offset shift over a frequency
range of 10 Hz to 20 MHz was less than 6 V RTI. At
unity gain, there was no measurable dc offset shift.
The RFI filter should be built using a PC board with
ground planes on both sides. All component leads should
be made as short as possible. The input filter common
should be connected to the amplifier common using the
most direct path. Avoid building the filter and the in-amp
circuits on separate boards or in separate enclosures, as
this extra lead length can create a loop antenna. Instead,
physically locate the filter right at the in-amp’s input
terminals. A further precaution is to use good quality
resistors that are both noninductive and nonthermal
(low TC). Resistors R1 and R2 can be common 1%
metal film units. However, all three capacitors need to
be reasonably high Q, low loss components. Capacitors
C1a and C1b need to be 5% tolerance devices to avoid
degrading the circuit’s common-mode rejection. The
traditional 5% silver micas, miniature size micas, or
the new Panasonic 2% PPS film capacitors (Digi-Key
part # PS1H102G-ND) are recommended.
Selecting RFI Input Filter Component Values Using
a Cookbook Approach
The following general rules will greatly ease the design
of an RC input filter.
1. First, decide on the value of the two series resistors while ensuring that the previous circuitry can
adequately drive this impedance. With typical values
between 2 k and 10 k, these resistors should not
contribute more noise than that of the in-amp itself.
Using a pair of 2 k resistors will add a Johnson noise
of 8 nV/√Hz; this increases to 11 nV/√Hz with 4 k
resistors and to 18 nV/√Hz with 10 k resistors.
2.Next, select an appropriate value for capacitor C2,
which sets the filter’s differential (signal) bandwidth.
It’s always best to set this as low as possible without
attenuating the input signal. A differential bandwidth
of 10 times the highest signal frequency is usually
adequate.
3. Then select values for capacitors C1a and C1b, which
set the common-mode bandwidth. For decent ac
CMR, these should be 10% the value of C2 or less.
The common-mode bandwidth should always be less
than 10% of the in-amp’s bandwidth at unity gain.
5-14
Specific Design Examples
An RFI Circuit for AD620 Series In-Amps
Figure 5-26 is a circuit for general-purpose in-amps such
as the AD620 series, which have higher noise levels
(12 nV/√Hz) and lower bandwidths than the AD8221.
Accordingly, the same input resistors were used, but
capacitor C2 was increased approximately five times
to 0.047 F to provide adequate RF attenuation. With
the values shown, the circuit’s –3 dB bandwidth is approximately 400 Hz; the bandwidth may be increased
to 760 Hz by reducing the resistance of R1 and R2
to 2.2 k. Note that this increased bandwidth does not
come free. It requires the circuitry preceding the in-amp
to drive a lower impedance load and results in somewhat
less input overload protection.
An RFI Circuit for Micropower In-Amps
Some in-amps are more prone to RF rectification than
others and may need a more robust filter. A micropower
in-amp, such as the AD627, with its low input stage
operating current, is a good example. The simple
expedient of increasing the value of the two input
resistors, R1a/R1b, and/or that of capacitor C2, will
provide further RF attenuation, at the expense of a
reduced signal bandwidth.
Since the AD627 in-amp has higher noise (38 nV/√Hz)
than general-purpose ICs, such as the AD620 series
devices, higher value input resistors can be used without
seriously degrading the circuit’s noise performance.
The basic RC RFI circuit of Figure 5-24 was modified
to include higher value input resistors, as shown in
Figure 5-27.
The filter bandwidth is approximately 200 Hz. At a gain
of 100, the maximum dc offset shift with a 1 V p-p input
applied is approximately 400 V RTI over an input range
of 1 Hz to 20 MHz. At the same gain, the circuit’s RF
signal rejection (RF level at output/RF applied to the
input) will be better than 61 dB.
RFI FILTER
R1a
4.02k
+IN
0.01F
C1a
1000pF
3
+VS
0.33F
7
+
1
C2
0.047F
R1b
4.02k
–IN
6
AD620
RG
8
2
C1b
1000pF
VOUT
5
–
4
REF
0.01F
0.33F
–VS
Figure 5-26. RFI circuit for AD620 series in-amp.
RFI FILTER
+IN
20k
0.01F
C1a
1000pF
3
+
+VS
0.33F
7
1
C2
0.022F
–IN
8
20k
2
C1b
1000pF
6
AD627
RG
5
–
4
REF
0.33F
0.01F
–VS
Figure 5-27. RFI suppression circuit for the AD627.
5-15
VOUT
An RFI Filter for the AD623 In-Amp
AD8225 RFI Filter Circuit
Figure 5-28 shows the recommended RFI circuit for
use with the AD623 in-amp. Because this device is less
prone to RFI than the AD627, the input resistors can
be reduced in value from 20 k to 10 k; this increases
the circuit’s signal bandwidth and lowers the resistors’
noise contribution. Moreover, the 10 k resistors still
provide very effective input protection. With the values
shown, the bandwidth of this filter is approximately
400 Hz. Operating at a gain of 100, the maximum dc
offset shift with a 1 V p-p input is less than 1 V RTI.
At the same gain, the circuit’s RF signal rejection is
better than 74 dB.
Figure 5-29 shows the recommended RFI filter for this
in-amp. The AD8225 in-amp has a fixed gain of 5 and a
bit more susceptibility to RFI than the AD8221.Without
the RFI filter, with a 2 V p-p, 10 Hz to 19 MHz sine wave
applied, this in-amp measures about 16 mV RTI of dc
offset. The filter used provides a heavier RF attenuation
than that of the AD8221 circuit by using larger resistor
values: 10 k instead of 4 k.This is permissible because
of the AD8225’s higher noise level. Using the filter, there
was no measurable dc offset error.
RFI FILTER
+IN
10k
0.01F
C1a
1000pF
3
+
+VS
0.33F
7
1
C2
0.022F
–IN
6
AD623
RG
8
10k
2
C1b
1000pF
VOUT
5
–
4
0.01F
REF
0.33F
–VS
Figure 5-28. AD623 RFI suppression circuit.
RFI FILTER
+IN
10k
0.01F
C1a
1000pF
2
+
C2
0.01F
–IN
+VS
0.33F
7
6
AD8225
5
10k
3
C1b
1000pF
–
4
0.01F
REF
0.33F
–VS
Figure 5-29. AD8225 RFI filter circuit.
5-16
VOUT
An RFI Filter For The AD8555 Sensor
Amplifier
In-Amps with On-Chip EMI/RFI Filtering
The AD8556 is very similar to the AD8555. The
AD8556 features internal EMI filters on the –IN, +IN,
FILT, and VCLAMP pins. These built-in filters on the
pins limit the interference bandwidth and provide good
RFI suppression without reducing performance within
the pass band of the in-amp. A functional diagram of
AD8556 along with its EMI/RFI filters is shown in
Figure 5-31.
The circuit in Figure 5-30 provides good RFI suppression
without reducing performance within the AD8555 pass
band. Using the component values shown, this filter has
a common-mode bandwidth of approximately 40 kHz.
To preserve common-mode rejection in the AD8555’s
pass band, capacitors need to be 5% (silver mica) or
better and should be placed as close to its inputs as possible. Resistors should be 1% metal film. The circuit’s
differential bandwidth is approximately 4 kHz when a
C3 value of 0.047 mF is used.
VDD
–IN
+IN
VSS
R2
4.02k6
C3
0.047MF
AD8556 has on-chip filters on its inputs, VCLAMP,
and filter pins. The first-order low-pass filters inside
the AD8556 are useful to reject high frequency EMI
signals picked up by wires and PCB traces outside
the AD8556. The most sensitive pin of any amplifier
to RFI/EMI signal is the noninverting pin. Signals
present at this pin appear as common-mode signals
and create problems.
1
VDD
2
FILT/DIGOUT
3
DIGIN
4
–IN
C2
1nF
VSS 8
VOUT 7
VCLAMP 6
VDD
The filters at the input of the AD8556 have two different
bandwidths: common and differential mode. The EMI
filters placed on the input pins of the AD8556 reject
EMI/RFI suppressions that appear as common-mode
signals.
+IN 5
C1
1nF
AD8555
R1
4.02k6
Figure 5-30. AD8555 RFI filter circuit.
DIGIN
VCLAMP
VDD
EMI
FILTER
DAC
LOGIC
1
2
+IN
A5 OUT 3
–IN
VSS
VDD
VPOS
1
EMI
FILTER
2
+IN
3
A1 OUT
–IN
R5
P4
R7
R2
VSS
P2
VDD
EMI
FILTER
R3
1
+IN
3
A3 OUT
2
–IN
P1
VDD
VDD
RF
EMI
FILTER
1
2
+IN
3
A4 OUT
–IN
VSS
1
VNEG
+IN
3
A2 OUT
2
–IN
EMI
FILTER
VSS
R1
R4
VSS
R5
P3
AD8556
VSS
FILT/DIGOUT
Figure 5-31. AD8556 block diagram showing on-chip EMI/RFI filter.
5-17
VOUT
Figure 5-32 simulates the presence of a noisy commonmode signal, and Figure 5-33 shows the response dc
values at VOUT.
+2.5V
+2.5V
–2.5V
U2
1
–2.5V
2
U3
1
2
3
VCC
VEE
FILTER
VOUT
8
7
AD8556
+IN
GAIN = 70
DC OFFSET = 2.5V
VCLAMP
AD8556
7
6
GAIN = 70
DC OFFSET = 2.5V
VOUT
+2.5V
+IN 5
+
–
V2
Figure 5-34. Test circuit to show AD8556
performance exposed to differential-mode
RFI/EMI signals.
The response of AD8556 to EMI/RFI differential signals
is shown in Figure 5-35.
Figure 5-32. Test circuit to show AD8556
performance exposed to common-mode
RFI/EMI signals.
!$
$#/&&3%4M6
$%6)!4)/.&2/-$#/54054M6
VOUT
8
200mV p-p
NOISE
INPUT
+
–
DATA
+2.5V
5
VEE
FILTER
4 –IN
VOUT
(0V)
VCLAMP 6
DATA
4 –IN
3
VCC
./.%-)02/4%#4%$3/,54)/.
n
./.%-)02/4%#4%$3/,54)/.
n
n
n
n
n
n
!$%.(!.#%$0!24&/2%-)
&2%15%.#9-(Z
Figure 5-35. DC offset shift of AD8556 due to
EMI/RFI differential signals vs. frequency.
n
&2%15%.#9-(Z
Figure 5-33. DC input offset values at VOUT
caused by common-mode RFI vs. frequency.
The differential bandwidth defines the frequency response
of the filters with a differential signal applied between
the two inputs, VPOS (that is, +IN ) and VNEG (that
is, –IN). Figure 5-34 shows the test circuit for AD8556
EMI/RFI susceptibility.
For the most effective EMI rejection, the printed circuit
board leads at VPOS and VNEG should be as similar as
possible. In this way, any EMI received by the VPOS
and VNEG pins will be similar (that is, a common-mode
input), and rejected by the AD8556. Furthermore, additional filtering at the VPOS and VNEG pins should
provide better reduction of unwanted behavior compared
with filtering at the other pins.
5-18
Common-Mode Filters Using X2Y® Capacitors*
Figure 5-36 shows the connection diagram for an X2Y
capacitor. These are very small, three terminal devices
with four external connections—A, B, G1, and G2.
The G1 and G2 terminals connect internally within the
device. The internal plate structure of the X2Y capacitor forms an integrated circuit with very interesting
properties. Electrostatically, the three electrical nodes
form two capacitors that share the G1 and G2 terminals.
The manufacturing process automatically matches both
capacitors very closely. In addition, the X2Y structure
includes an effective autotransformer/common-mode
choke. As a result, when these devices are used for
common-mode filters, they provide greater attenuation
of common-mode signals above the filter’s corner
frequency than a comparable RC filter.This usually allows
the omission of capacitor C2, with subsequent savings in
cost and board space.
C3 +V
C4
330nF S 10nF
–IN
+IN
Figure 5-36. X2Y electrostatic model.
+IN
R1B
4.02k� 1%
RG
IA
6
VOUT
5
C5
330nF
C6
10nF
D"
n
#/.6%.4)/.!,
#-&),4%2
n
n
n
n
K
K
K
&2%15%.#9(Z
-
'
Figure 5-38. RF attenuation, X2Y vs.
conventional RC common-mode filter.
8
U1
7
IA
6
AD8221
3
4 +
7
AD8221
3
4 +
n
C3 +VS C4
330nF
10nF
1
–
2
RG
8
U1
Figure 5-37a illustrates a conventional RC commonmode filter, while Figure 5-37b shows a common-mode
filter circuit using an X2Y device. Figure 5-38 is a
graph contrasting the RF attenuation provided by
these two filters.
C1A
220pF C2
C1B 10nF
220pF
1
–
2
Figure 5-37b. Common-mode filter
using X2Y capacitor.
2&!44%.5!4)/.D"
"
–IN
R1B
4.02k6 1%
89#-&),4%2
'
R1A
4.02k� 1%
C1*
10nF
–VS
!
'
R1A
4.02k6 1%
VOUT
5
C5
330nF
C6
10nF
–VS
Figure 5-37a. Conventional RC
common-mode filter.
*C1 is part number 500X14W103KV4. X2Y components may be purchased from Johanson Dielectrics, Sylmar, CA 91750, (818) 364-9800. For a full
listing of X2Y manufacturers, visit www.x2y.com/manufacturers.
5-19
Using Common-Mode RF Chokes for In-Amp
RFI Filters
As an alternative to using an RC input filter, a commercial
common-mode RF choke may be connected in front of
an in-amp, as shown in Figure 5-39. A common-mode
choke is a two-winding RF choke using a common
core. Any RF signals that are common to both inputs
will be attenuated by the choke. The common-mode
choke provides a simple means for reducing RFI with
a minimum of components and provides a greater
signal pass band, but the effectiveness of this method
depends on the quality of the particular common-mode
choke being used. A choke with good internal matching
is preferred. Another potential problem with using the
choke is that there is no increase in input protection as
is provided by the RC RFI filters.
Using an AD620 in-amp with the RF choke specified, at
a gain of 1000, and a 1 V p-p common-mode sine wave
applied to the input, the circuit of Figure 5-39 reduces
the dc offset shift to less than 4.5 V RTI. The high
frequency common-mode rejection ratio was also greatly
improved, as shown in Table 5-3.
Table 5-3. AC CMR vs. Frequency
Using the Circuit of Figure 5-39
Frequency
CMRR (dB)
100 kHz 333 kHz 350 kHz 500 kHz 1 MHz 100
83
79
88
96
Because some in-amps are more susceptible to RFI than
others, the use of a common-mode choke may sometimes
prove inadequate. In these cases, an RC input filter or
an X2Y-based filter is a better choice.
0.01F
+VS
0.33F
PULSE
ENGINEERING
#B4001 COMMON-MODE
RF CHOKE
+
+IN
RG
VOUT
IN-AMP
–
–IN
REF
0.01F
0.33F
–VS
Figure 5-39. Using a commercial common-mode RF choke for RFI suppression.
5-20
RFI TESTING
 VIN 
 2 


CMR = 20 log
 VOUT 
 Gain 


Figure 5-40 shows a typical setup for measuring RFI
rejection. To test these circuits for RFI suppression,
connect the two input terminals together using very
short leads. Connect a good quality sine wave generator
to this input via a 50  terminated cable.
Using an oscilloscope, adjust the generator for a 1 V
peak-to-peak output at the generator end of the cable.
Set the in-amp to operate at high gain (such as a gain
of 100). DC offset shift is simply read directly at the
in-amp’s output using a DVM. For measuring high
frequency CMR, use an oscilloscope connected to the
in-amp output by a compensated scope probe and measure
the peak-to-peak output voltage (i.e., feedthrough) vs.
input frequency.When calculating CMRR vs. frequency,
remember to take into account the input termination
(VIN/2) and the gain of the in-amp.
USING LOW-PASS FILTERING TO IMPROVE
SIGNAL-TO-NOISE RATIO
To extract data from a noisy measurement, low-pass filtering can be used to greatly improve the signal-to-noise
ratio of the measurement by removing all signals that are
not within the signal bandwidth. In some cases, band-pass
filtering (reducing response both below and above the
signal frequency) can be employed for an even greater
improvement in measurement resolution.
+VS
RF
SIGNAL
GENERATOR CABLE
+
RFI
INPUT
FILTER
VOUT TO
SCOPE OR DVM
IN-AMP
RG
–
REF
–VS
Figure 5-40. Typical test setup for measuring an in-amp’s RFI rejection.
5-21
The 1 Hz, 4-pole, active filter of Figure 5-41 is an example
of a very effective low-pass filter that normally would be
added after the signal has been amplified by the in-amp.
This filter provides high dc precision at low cost while
requiring a minimum number of components.
Furthermore, since the input bias current of these op
amps is as low as their input offset currents over most
of the MIL temperature range, there is rarely a need to
use the normal balancing resistor (along with its noisereducing bypass capacitor). Note, however, that adding
the optional balancing resistor will enhance performance
at temperatures above 100C.
Note that component values can simply be scaled
to provide corner frequencies other than 1 Hz (see
Table 5-4). If a 2-pole filter is preferred, simply take
the output from the first op amp.
Specified values are for a –3 dB point of 1.0 Hz.
For other frequencies, simply scale capacitors C1
through C4 directly; i.e., for 3 Hz Bessel response,
C1 = 0.0387 F, C2 = 0.0357 F, C3 = 0.0533 F,
and C4 = 0.0205 F.
The low levels of current noise, input offset, and input
bias currents in the quad op amp (either an AD704 or
OP497) allow the use of 1 M resistors without sacrificing
the 1 µV/C drift of the op amp. Thus, lower capacitor
values may be used, reducing cost and space.
C1
4C2
Q1 =
W=
1
W=
R6 C1C2
R6 = R7
C1
INPUT
R6
1M
R7
1M
C3
4C4
Q2 =
1
R8 C3C4
R8 = R9
1/2 AD706*
1/2 OP297*
C3
R8
C2
1M
R10
1M
* REFER TO THE ANALOG DEVICES WEBSITE AT
WWW.ANALOG.COM FOR THE LATEST OP AMP
PRODUCTS AND SPECIFICATIONS.
OUTPUT
C4
2M
R10
C5
A1, A2 ARE AD706 OR OP297
1/2 AD706
1/2 OP297
R9
2M
C5
OPTIONAL BALANCE
RESISTOR NETWORKS
CAN BE REPLACED
WITH A SHORT
0.01 F
CAPACITORS C 2 –C4 ARE
SOUTHERN ELECTRONICS
MPCC, POLYCARBONATE,
5%, 50V
Figure 5-41. A 4-pole low-pass filter for data acquisition.
Table 5-4. Recommended Component Values for a 1 Hz, 4-Pole, Low-Pass Filter
Desired Low-
Pass Response
Section 1
Frequency
Frequency
(Hz)
Q
(Hz)
(Q)
Section 2
C1
C2
(F)
(F)
C3
(F)
C4
(F)
Bessel
Butterworth
0.1 dB Chebychev
0.2 dB Chebychev
0.5 dB Chebychev
1.0 dB Chebychev
1.43
1.00
0.648
0.603
0.540
0.492
0.116
0.172
0.304
0.341
0.416
0.508
0.160
0.416
0.733
0.823
1.00
1.23
0.0616
0.0609
0.0385
0.0347
0.0290
0.0242
0.522
0.541
0.619
0.646
0.705
0.785
1.60
1.00
0.948
0.941
0.932
0.925
0.806
1.31
2.18
2.44
2.94
3.56
5-22
0.107
0.147
0.198
0.204
0.209
0.206
EXTERNAL CMR AND SETTLING TIME
ADJUSTMENTS
AC CMR trimming is accomplished in a similar
manner, except that an ac input signal is applied. The
input frequency used should be somewhat lower than the
–3 dB bandwidth of the circuit.
When a very high speed, wide bandwidth in-amp is
needed, one common approach is to use several op amps
or a combination of op amps and a high bandwidth
subtractor amplifier. These discrete designs may be
readily tuned up for best CMR performance by external
trimming. A typical circuit is shown in Figure 5-42. The
dc CMR should always be trimmed first, since it affects
CMRR at all frequencies.
The input amplitude should be set at 20 V p-p with
the inputs tied together. The ac CMR trimmer is then
nulled-set to provide the lowest output possible. If the
best possible settling time is needed, the ac CMR
trimmer may be used, while observing the output wave
form on an oscilloscope. Note that, in some cases, there
will be a compromise between the best CMR and the
fastest settling time.
The +VIN and –VIN terminals should be tied together
and a dc input voltage applied between the two inputs
and ground. The voltage should be adjusted to provide
a 10 V dc input. A dc CMR trimming potentiometer
would then be adjusted so that the outputs are equal and
as low as possible, with both a positive and a negative
dc voltage applied.
VIN#1
INVERTING
INPUT
AC CMR TRIM
R1
A1
CT
R2
SENSE
R5
RG
COMMON-MODE
INPUT SIGNAL
(AC OR DC)
VIN#2
NONINVERTING
INPUT
A3
OUTPUT
DC CMR TRIM
R6
A2
R3
1/2 CT
R4
Figure 5-42. External dc and ac CMR trim circuit for a discrete 3-op amp in-amp.
5-23
REF
Chapter VI
IN-AMP AND DIFF AMP APPLICATIONS CIRCUITS
A True Differential Output In-Amp Circuit
The AD8222 can be easily configured as a true differential
output in-amp, as shown in Figure 6-1. Note that this
connection provides a low impedance output at both
+OUT and –OUT.
ground would be connected to the VREF1 terminal. This
would produce a common-mode output voltage of half
the ADC reference voltage.
0.1MF
+VS
Because the differential voltage is set solely by Amplifier
A1, all of the precision specifications (offset voltage, offset
drift, and 1/f noise) are the same as if Amplifier A1 were
operating in single-ended mode.
RG
+IN
Amplifier A1 sets the differential output voltage by
maintaining the following equation:
16
1
–IN
2
3
4
6
VDIFFOUT = V+OUT – V–OUT =
(V+IN – V–IN) 3 GainA1
(V− OUT + V+ OUT ) = (VREF 2 + VREF1 )
A2
7
–VS
Because theVREF1 andVREF2 pins have different properties,
the reference voltage may be easily set for a wide variety
of applications. Note that VREF2 is high impedance but
cannot swing to the supply rails of the part. In contrast,
VREF1 must be driven with a low impedance but can go
300 mV beyond the supply rails. One very common
application sets the common-mode output voltage to
the midscale of a differential ADC. In this case, the ADC
reference voltage would be sent to theVREF2 terminal and
100pF
VREF2
VREF1
–OUT
Figure 6-1. Differential output in-amp circuit.
Figure 6-2 shows two conventional methods used to
measure a large signal. One comprises a 2-resistor divider
and an output buffer, the other an inverter with a large
value input resistor. Both approaches suffer from the fact
that only one resistor dissipates power and, therefore, is
self-heating and the change in resistance due to temperature change results in a large nonlinearity error. Another
problem associated with these approaches concerns
the amplifier: The combination of offset current, offset
voltage, CMRR, gain error, and drifts of the amplifier
and resistors may significantly reduce the overall system
performance.
20k6
380k6
400k6
VIN
20k6
20k6
10k6
DIFFERENCE AMPLIFIER MEASURES HIGH
VOLTAGES
2
20k6
9
0.1MF 13
Amplifier A2 sets the output common-mode voltage by
maintaining the following equation:
2
+OUT
1/2
1/2
AD8222
AD8222
G=1
12
(RG = @)
14
The output common-mode voltage is set by the average
of VREF2 voltage and VREF1.
VCMOUT =
15
A1
VOUT
VIN
VOUT
Figure 6-2. Two conventional methods of measuring high voltage.
6-1
Clearly, something better is needed. Figure 6-3 is a
schematic of a circuit that can measure in excess of
400 volts peak-to-peak input with less than five parts
per million nonlinearity error. The circuit attenuates an
input signal 20 times and also provides output buffering.
The amplifier, as well as the attenuator resistors, are
all packaged together inside the AD629 IC so that both
resistors in the attenuator string are at the same temperature. The amplifier stage employs superbeta transistors,
so that offset current error and bias current errors are
small. Also, since there is no noise gain (i.e., there is 100%
feedback at low frequencies), the AD629’s offset voltage
and its drift add almost no additional error.
T
1
2
CH1 100V
AD629
1
2
VIN
–VS
3
4
REF(–) 21.1k6
–IN
380k6
+IN
380k6
–VS
0.1MF
380k6
NC 8
REF(+)
20k6
6
CH1
6V
+VS
+VS 7
OUT
M 200Ms
0.1MF
VOUT
5
VOUT (50V/DIV)
30pF
CH2 5.00V
Figure 6-4. Performance photo: top, input voltage
(400 V p-p), bottom, output voltage (20 V p-p).
Figure 6-3. New high voltage
measurement system.
The AD629 cannot work with a 100% feedback. A
30 pF capacitor adds a pole and a zero to the feedback gain, so stability is maintained and the system
bandwidth is maximized. The pole is at
fp = 1/(2p (380 kV + 20 kV) 30 pF) = 13 kHz
VOUTPUT (5V/DIV)
The zero frequency is at
Figure 6-5. Cross plot of the high voltage
measurement system.
fz = 1/(2p (20 kV) 30 pF) = 265 kHz
NONLINEARITY (10ppm/DIV)
Figure 6-4 is a performance photo showing a 400 V p-p
input (top) and a 20 V p-p output (bottom). Figure 6-5
is a performance photo showing the output at 5 V p-p
per division vs. the input signal at 50 V p-p per division.
Figure 6-6, also a cross plot, shows nonlinearity vs. the
input signal.
INPUT VOLTAGE (50V/DIV)
Figure 6-6. Nonlinearity error of the high voltage
measurement system:
Y axis: output nonlinearity error, 10 ppm/division.
X axis: input voltage, 50 volts/division.
6-2
Precision Current Source
Integrator for PID Loop
Figure 6-7 shows the AD8553 configured as a current
source. The current output node voltage (labeled IOUT)
sets the voltage at the VREF pin of the AD8553.The input
signal to the AD8553, VIN, sets the current that flows
through R1. Consequently, the voltage drop across R2
is set by VIN, according to the following equation:
Figure 6-8 shows the AD8553 configured as an integrator. This configuration can be used within a PID
(proportional integral differential) loop in a control
system. In this case, the integrator’s gain becomes
one at F UNITY = 1/(p(R1)CI ). Note that this result
is due to the fact that the AD8553 doubles the current through R1, resulting in an effective resistance
(R1)/2. The input offset voltage of this configuration
will be proportional to the size of R1, assuming that
the system is in a steady state condition. Therefore,
the input offset voltage of the integrator is determined
primarily by the size of R1 along with the internal
offsets of the AD8553, assuming that the system is in
a steady state condition.
VR2 = 2(VIN/R1)R2
C2
1MF
VCC
3
2
(+)
VIN
VIN
R
6
1
AD8553
R1
200k6
2VIN
R1
10
(–)
5
R2
19.1k6
4
RSET
2006
7
9
IOUT
8
LOAD
Figure 6-7. Precision 61 mA dc current source.
5V
6
2
2
CI
1MF
3
5
1
R1
200k6
AD8553
4
10
9
9
fU =
7
8
VREF
Now, the voltage between VOUT and VREF is equal to VR2.
As a result, the output current from this current source is
IOUT = (VR2/RSET). The value of this current can range
between 61 mA. This is 0.8 V < V(@IOUT) < VCC – 0.8
(single supply). Note that this range is limited by the
dynamic range of the VREF pin on the AD8553. This
compliance range would include ground on dual-supply
systems. If R1 is adjusted, ensure that the current in R1
stays below 19 mA. If R2 values are adjusted, ensure that
Pin 4 of the AD8553 does not exceed its valid output
range (75 mV from each supply). This current source
could be used to transmit a signal from one location to
another distant location and transform it back into a
voltage at the distant location using a transimpedance
amplifier.
Composite In-Amp Circuit Has Excellent High
Frequency CMR
The primary benefit of an in-amp circuit is that it
provides common-mode rejection.While the AD8221
and AD8225 both have an extended CMR frequency
range, most in-amps fail to provide decent CMR at
frequencies above the audio range.
1
R1
2P
( CI )
2
( )
Figure 6-8. Low frequency differential input
integrators for PID loop.
6-3
/54
#-2D"
The circuit in Figure 6-9 is a composite instrumentation
amplifier with a high common-mode rejection ratio. It
features an extended frequency range over which the
instrumentation amplifier has good common-mode
rejection (Figure 6-10). The circuit consists of three
instrumentation amplifiers.Two of these, U1 and U2, are
correlated to one another and connected in antiphase. It
is not necessary to match these devices because they are
correlated by design. Their outputs, OUT1 and OUT2,
drive a third instrumentation amplifier that rejects
common-mode signals and amplifiers’ differential signals.
The overall gain of the system can be determined by
adding external resistors. Without any external resistors,
the system gain is 2 (Figure 6-11). The performance of
the circuit with a gain of 100 is shown in Figure 6-12.
U1
+
K
+
U3
OUT3
AD623
REF
–
+VS
VCM
K
&2%15%.#9(Z
+VS
–VS
+
K
Figure 6-11. CMR vs. frequency at a gain of 2.
OUT2
U2
AD623
REF
–
/54
#-2D"
+
OUT1
AD623
REF
–
VDM
/54
+VS
+
–VS
/54
VREF
–VS
Figure 6-9. A composite instrumentation amplifier.
COMMON-MODE
SIGNAL,
3.5V p-p @ 20kHz
(1V/DIV)
UNCORRECTED
CMRR ERROR
(10mV/DIV)
OUTPUT SIGNAL
(1mV/DIV)
VCM
OUT1
OUT3
K
K
&2%15%.#9(Z
K
Figure 6-12. CMR of the system at a gain of 100.
Since U1 and U2 are correlated, their common-mode
errors are the same. Therefore, these errors appear as
common-mode input signal to U3, which rejects them.
In fact, if it is necessary, OUT1 and OUT2 can directly
drive an analog-to-digital converter (ADC), as seen in
Figure 6-13. The differential-input stage of the ADC
normally will reject the common-mode signal.
Figure 6-10. CMR of the circuit in Figure 6-9 at 20 kHz.
6-4
is a dc output proportional to the strain on the bridge.
The output signal is devoid of all dc errors associated
with the in-amp and the detector, including offset and
offset drift.
+VS
+
OUT1
U1
AD623
REF
–
VDM
+
AD7825
+IN
–VS
VCM
+
In Figure 6-14, a 400 Hz signal excites the bridge. The
signal at the AD8221’s input is an ac voltage. Similarly,
the signal at the input of the AD630 is ac; the signal is dc
at the end of the low-pass filter following the AD630.
DIGITAL
DATA
OUTPUT
–IN
+VS
+
+VS
VREF GND
The 400 Hz ac signal is rectified and then averaged; dc
errors are converted in an ac signal and removed by the
AD630. Ultimately, a precision dc signal is obtained.
OUT2
U2
AD623
REF
–
–VS
The AD8221 is well-suited for this application because
its high CMRR over frequency ensures that the signal
of interest, which appears as a small difference voltage
riding on a large sinusoidal common-mode voltage, is
gained and the common-mode signal is rejected. In
typical instrumentation amplifiers, CMRR falls off at
about 200 Hz. In contrast, the AD8221 continues to
reject common-mode signals beyond 10 kHz.
–VS
Figure 6-13. The OUT1 and OUT2 signals of
the first stage can directly drive an analogto-digital converter, allowing the ADC to
reject the common-mode signal.
Strain Gage Measurement Using An
AC Excitation
Strain gage measurements are often plagued by offset
drift, 1/f noise, and line noise. One solution is to use an
ac signal to excite the bridge, as shown in Figure 6-14.
The AD8221 gains the signal and an AD630AR
synchronously demodulates the waveform. What results
If an ac source is not available, a commutating voltage
may be constructed using switches. The AD8221’s high
CMRR over frequency rejects high frequency harmonics
from a commutating voltage source.
+15V
+15V
350
350
0.1F
350
350
10F
+IN
AD8221
49.9
REF
–IN
0.1F
10F
+15V
9
11
SEL B
+VS
16
RA
17
RINB
19
CHB–
AD630AR
VOUT 13
CHA–
15
RF RINA SEL A –VS RB
1
4.99k
4.99k
2F
2F
2F
COMP 12
20
–15V
4.99k
10
8
14
–15V
Figure 6-14. Using an ac signal to excite the bridge.
6-5
OP1177
–15V
Applications of the AD628 Precision
Gain Block
The AD628 can be operated as either a differential/scaling amplifier or as a pin-strapped precision gain block.
Specifically designed for use ahead of an analog-to-digital
converter, the AD628 is extremely useful as an input
scaling and buffering amplifier. As a differential amplifier,
it can extract small differential voltages riding on large
common-mode voltages up to 120 V. As a prepackaged precision gain block, the pins of the AD628 can
be strapped to provide a wide range of precision gains,
­allowing for high accuracy data acquisition with very
little gain or offset drift.
The AD628 uses an absolute minimum of external components. Its tiny MSOP provides these functions in the
smallest size package available on the market. Besides
high gain accuracy and low drift, the AD628 provides a
very high common-mode rejection, typically more than
90 dB at 1 kHz while still maintaining a 60 dB CMRR
at 100 kHz.
The AD628 includes a VREF pin to allow a dc (midscale)
offset for driving single-supply ADCs. In this case, the
VREF pin may simply be tied to the ADC’s reference pin,
which also allows easy ratiometric operation.
Why Use a Gain Block IC?
Real-world measurement requires extracting weak signals
from noisy sources. Even when a differential measurement
is made, high common-mode voltages are often present.
The usual solution is to use an op amp or, better still, an
in-amp, and then perform some type of low-pass filtering
to reduce the background noise level.
The problem with this traditional approach is that a
­discrete op amp circuit will have poor common-mode
rejection and its input voltage range will always be less than
the power supply voltage. When used with a differential
signal source, an in-amp circuit using a monolithic IC
will improve common-mode rejection. However, signal
sources greater than the power supply voltage, or signals
riding on high common-mode voltages, cannot handle
standard in-amps. In addition, in-amps using a single
external gain resistor suffer from gain drift. Finally, lowpass filtering usually requires the addition of a separate
op amp, along with several external components. This
drains valuable board space.
The AD628 eliminates these common problems by
functioning as a scaling amplifier between the sensor,
the shunt resistor, or another point of data acquisition,
as well as the ADC. Its 120 V max input range permits
the direct measurement of large signals or small signals
riding on large common-mode voltages.
Standard Differential Input ADC Buffer Circuit
with Single-Pole LP Filter
Figure 6-15 shows the AD628 connected to accept a
differential input signal riding on a very high commonmode voltage. The AD628 gain block has two internal
ampli­fiers: A1 and A2. Pin 3 is grounded, thus operating
amplifier A1 at a gain of 0.1. The 100 k input resistors and other aspects of its design allow the AD628 to
­process small input signals riding on common-mode
voltages up to 120 V.
C1
+15V
0.1F
CFILTER
4
+VS
10k
DIFFERENTIAL
INPUT SIGNAL
8
100k
AD628
– IN
10k
A1
VIN
1
100k
–VS
2
VOUT
TO ADC
+ IN
A2
+ IN
5
– IN
10k
VCM
7
VREF
RG
3
6
0.1F
RG
–15V
RF
Figure 6-15. Basic differential input connection with single-pole LP filter.
6-6
The output of A1 connects to the plus input of amplifier
A2 through a 10 k resistor. Pin 4 allows connecting an
external capacitor to this point, providing single-pole
low-pass filtering.
Changing the Output Scale Factor
Figure 6-15 reveals that the output scale factor of the
AD628 may be set by changing the gain of amplifier
A2. This uncommitted op amp may be operated at any
convenient gain higher than unity. When configured,
the AD628 may be set to provide circuit gains between
0.1 and 1000.
Since the gain of A1 is 0.1, the combined gain of A1
and A2 equals
VOUT
= G = 0.1 1 + ( RF RG )
VIN
(
Therefore,
)
RF
RG
(10G − 1) =
For ADC-buffering applications, the gain of A2 should
be chosen so that the voltage driving the ADC is close
to its full-scale input range. The use of external ­resistors,
RF and RG to set the output scale factor (i.e., gain of A2)
will degrade gain accuracy and drift essentially to the
resistors themselves.
A separate VREF pin is available for offsetting the AD628
output signal, so it is centered in the middle of the ADC’s
input range. Although Figure 6-15 indicates 15 V, the
circuit may be operated from 2.25 V to 18 V dual
supplies. This VREF pin may also be used to allow singlesupply operation; VREF may simply be biased at VS/2.
Using an External Resistor to Operate the AD628 at
Gains Below 0.1
The AD628 gain block may be modified to provide any
desired gain from 0.01 to 0.1, as shown in Figure 6-16.
This connection is the same as the basic wide input range
circuit of Figure 6-15, but with Pins 5 and 6 strapped,
and with an external resistor, RG, connection between
Pin 4 and ground. The pin strapping operates amplifier
A2 at unity gain. Acting with the on-chip 10 k resistor
at the output of A1, RGAIN forms a voltage divider that
attenuates the signal between the output of A1 and
the input of A2. The gain for this connection equals
0.1 VIN ((10 k + RG)/RG).
RG
+15V
0.1F
7
4
CFILTER
+VS
10k
DIFFERENTIAL
INPUT SIGNAL
8
100k
AD628
– IN
10k
A1
VIN
1
100k
+ IN
A2
– IN
10k
VCM
–VS
2
VREF
RG
3
6
0.1F
–15V
Figure 6-16. AD628 connection for gains less than 0.1.
6-7
VOUT
TO ADC
+ IN
5
+15V
C1
0.1F
CFILTER
0.1F
7
4
+VS
10k
DIFFERENTIAL
INPUT SIGNAL
8
100k
AD628
–
IN
10k
A1
VIN
100k
1
+
– IN
–VS
2
5
A2
IN
10k
VCM
VOUT
TO ADC
+ IN
RG
VREF
3
6
C2
0.1F
RG
–15V
RF
Figure 6-17. Differential input circuit with 2-pole low-pass filtering.
Differential Input Circuit with 2-Pole
Low-Pass Filtering
10.0
RT = 49.9k�, RG = 12.4k�
C1 = 0.047�F, C2 = 0.01�F
As before, the first pole of the low-pass filter is set by
the internal 10 k resistor at the output of A1 and the
external capacitor C1. The second pole is created by
an external RC time constant in the feedback path of
A2, consisting of capacitor C2 across resistor R F.
Note that this second pole provides a more rapid
roll-off of frequencies above its RC corner frequency
(1/(2RC)) than a single-pole LP filter. However, as the
input ­ frequency is increased, the gain of amplifier A2
eventually drops to unity and will not be further reduced.
So, amplifier A2 will have a voltage gain set by the ratio
of RF/RG at frequencies below its –3 dB corner and will
have unity gain at higher frequencies.
OUTPUT VOLTAGE (V p-p)
The circuit in Figure 6-17 is a modification of the basic
ADC interface circuit. Here, 2-pole low-pass filtering is
added for the price of one additional capacitor (C2).
1.0
0.10
0.01
10
100
1k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
10k
100k
Figure 6-18. Frequency response of the
2-pole low-pass filter.
Figure 6-18 shows the filter’s output vs. frequency using
components chosen to provide a 200 Hz, –3 dB corner
frequency. There is a sharp roll-off between the corner
frequency and approximately 10 the corner frequency.
Above this point, the second pole starts to become less
effective, and the rate of ­attenuation is close to that of a
single-pole response.
6-8
Table 6-1.
when configured as gain blocks, most common amplifiers
have both gain errors and offset drift.
2-Pole LP Filter
Input Range: 10 V p-p FS for a 5 V p-p Output
RF = 49.9 k, RG = 12.4 k
–3 dB Corner Frequency
200 Hz 1 kHz
5 kHz
10 kHz
Capacitor C20.01 F 0.002 F 390 pF 220 pF
Capacitor C10.047 F 0.01 F 0.002 F0.001 F
The gain block circuits of Figures 6-19 to 6-23 overcome
all of these performance limitations, are very inexpensive,
and offer a single MSOP solution. The AD628 provides
this complete function using the smallest IC package
available. Since all resistors are internal to the AD628
gain block, both accuracy and drift are excellent.
Table 6-2.
2-Pole LP Filter
Input Range: 20 V p-p FS for a 5 V p-p Output
RF = 24.3 k, RG = 16.2 k
–3 dB Corner Frequency
200 Hz 1 kHz
5 kHz
In op amp circuits, the usual two-resistor gain setting
­arrangement has accuracy and drift limitations. Using
standard 1% resistors, amplifier gain can be off by 2%.
The gain will also vary with temperature because each
resistor will drift differently. Monolithic resistor networks
can be used for precise gain setting, but these components
increase cost, complexity, and board space.
10 kHz
Capacitor C2 0.02 F 0.0039 F 820 pF 390 pF
Capacitor C1 0.047 F 0.01 F 0.002 F 0.001 F
Tables 6-1 and 6-2 provide typical filter component
values for various –3 dB corner frequencies and two
different full-scale input ranges. Values have been
rounded off to match standard resistor and capacitor
values. Capacitors C1 and C2 need to be high Q, low
drift devices; low grade disc ceramics should be avoided.
High quality NPO ceramic, Mylar, or polyester film
capacitors are recommended for the lowest drift and
best settling time.
Using the AD628 to Create Precision Gain Blocks
Real-world data acquisition systems require amplifying weak
signals enough to apply them to an ADC. Unfortunately,
All of these pin-strapped circuits (using no external
components) have a gain accuracy better than 0.2%,
with a gain TC better than 50 ppm/°C.
Operating the AD628 as a +10 or –10 Precision
Gain Block
Figure 6-19 shows an AD628 precision gain block IC
connected to provide a voltage gain of +10. The gain
block may be configured to provide different gains by
strapping or grounding the appropriate pin. The gain
block itself consists of two internal amplifiers: a gain of
0.1 difference amplifier (A1) followed by an uncommitted
buffer amplifier (A2).
The input signal is applied between the VREF pin (Pin 3)
and ground. With the input tied to Pin 3, the voltage at
the positive input of A1 equals VIN (100 k/110 k),
which is VIN (10/11). With Pin 6 grounded, the minus
+15V
0.1F
CFILTER
4
+VS
10k
100k
8
100k
1
–
+
AD628
IN
A1
10k
+ IN
A2
IN
– IN
10k
–VS
2
7
3
5
VOUT
RG
VREF
6
0.1F
–15V
VIN
Figure 6-19. Circuit with a gain of +10 using no external components.
6-9
input of A2 equals 0 V. Therefore, the positive input of
A2 will be forced by feedback from the output of A2 to
be 0 V as well. The output of A1 then must also be at
0 V. Since the negative input of A1 must be equal to the
positive input of A1, both will equal VIN (10/11).
This means that the output voltage of A2 (VOUT) will
equal
VOUT = VIN (10 11) (1 + 100 k 10 k ) =
VIN (10 11) 11 = 10 VIN
The companion circuit in Figure 6-20 provides a gain of
–10. This time the input is applied between the negative
­input of A2 (Pin 6) and ground. Operation is exactly the
same, but now the input signal is inverted 180 by A2.
With Pin 3 grounded, the positive input of A1 is at 0 V,
so feedback will force the negative input of A1 to zero
as well. Since A1 operates at a gain of 1/10 (0.1), the
output of A2 that is needed to force the negative input
of A1 to zero is minus 10 VIN.
The two connections will have different input impedances.
When driving Pin 3 (Figure 6-19), the input impedance
to ground is 110 k, while it is approximately 50 G
when driving Pin 6 (Figure 6-20).The –3 dB bandwidth
for both circuits is approximately 110 kHz for 10 mV
and 95 kHz for 100 mV input signals.
Operating the AD628 at a Precision Gain of +11
The gain of +11 circuit (Figure 6-21) is almost identical to the gain of +10 connection, except that Pin 1 is
strapped to Pin 3, rather than being grounded. This
connects the two internal resistors (100 k and 10 k)
+15V
0.1F
7
4
CFILTER
+VS
10k
8
1
100k
100k
AD628
– IN
10k
A1
+
+ IN
IN
A2
5
VOUT
– IN
10k
–VS
2
RG
VREF
3
6
0.1F
–15V
VIN
Figure 6-20. Companion circuit providing a gain of –10.
7
4
CFILTER
+VS
10k
8
100k
AD628
– IN
10k
A1
1
100k
+
+ IN
IN
A2
– IN
10k
–VS
2
3
RG
VREF
6
VIN
Figure 6-21. A gain of +11 circuit.
6-10
5
VOUT
that are tied in parallel to the plus input of A1. So, this
now removes the 10 k/110 k voltage divider between
VIN and the positive input of A1.Thus modified,VIN drives
the positive input through approxi­mately a 9 k resistor.
Note that this series resistance is negligible compared to
the very high input impedance of amplifier A1. The gain
from Pin 8 to the output of A1 is 0.1.Therefore, feedback
will force the output of A2 to equal 10 VIN. The –3 dB
bandwidth of this circuit is approximately 105 kHz for
10 mV and 95 kHz for 100 mV input signals.
The input signal is applied between the V REF pin
and ground. Because Pins 1 and 8 are grounded, the
input signal runs through a 100 k/110 k input attenuator to the plus input of A1. The voltage equals VIN
(10/11) = 0.909 V IN. The gain from this point to the
output of A1 will equal 1 + (10 k/100 k) = 1.10.
Therefore, the voltage at the output of A1 will equal
V IN (1.10) (0.909) = 1.00. Amplifier A2 is operated
as a unity-gain buffer (as Pins 5 and 6 tied together),
providing an overall circuit gain of +1.
Operating the AD628 at a Precision Gain of +1
Figure 6-22 shows the AD628 connected to provide
a precision gain of +1. As before, this connection uses
the gain block’s internal resistor networks for high gain
accuracy and stability.
Increased BW Gain Block of –9.91 Using Feedforward
The circuit of Figure 6-20 can be modified slightly
by applying a small amount of positive feedback to
increase its bandwidth, as shown in Figure 6-23.
The output of amplifier A1 feeds back its positive
input by connecting Pin 4 and Pin 1 together. Now,
Gain = –(10 – 1/11) = –9.91.
+15V
0.1F
CFILTER
10k
100k
8
– IN
7
4
+VS
AD628
10k
+ IN
A1
100k
1
+
IN
–
10k
–VS
2
3
VOUT
A2
IN
5
RG
VREF
6
0.1F
–15V
VIN
Figure 6-22. AD628 precision gain of +1.
7
4
CFILTER
10k
8
100k
–
AD628
IN
10k
A1
1
100k
+
+VS
+ IN
IN
A2
– IN
10k
–VS
2
VREF
3
RG
6
VIN
Figure 6-23. Precision –10 gain block with feedforward.
6-11
5
VOUT
The resulting circuit is still stable because of the large
amount of negative feedback applied around the entire
circuit (from the output of A2 back to the negative
input of A1). This connection actually results in a small
signal –3 dB bandwidth of ­ approximately 140 kHz.
This is a 27% increase in bandwidth over the unmodified circuit in Figure 6-17. However, gain accuracy is
reduced to 2%.
CURRENT TRANSMITTER REJECTS
GROUND NOISE
Many systems use current flow to control remote instrumentations. The advantage of such a system is its ability
to operate with two remotely connected power supplies,
even if their grounds are not the same. In such cases, it is
necessary for the output to be linear with respect to the
input signal, and any interference between the grounds
must be rejected. Figure 6-24 shows such a circuit.
For this circuit,
IOUT =
(VIN
IOUT =
VIN
10)
1kΩ
where:
VOUT is measured between Pin 6 and its reference
(Pin 1 and Pin 5), and the input V IN is measured
between Pin 3 and Pin 2. The common-mode signal,
VCM, will be rejected.
In order to reduce the voltage at Pin 6, an inverter
with a gain of 9 is connected between Pin 6 and its
reference. The inverter sets the gain of the transmitter
such that for a 10 V input, the voltage at Pin 6 only
changes by 1 V; yet, the difference between Pin 6 and
its reference is 10 V.
Since the gain between the noninverting terminal of the
OP27 and the output of the AD629 is 1, no modulation
of the output current will take place as a function of the
output voltage VOUT. The scaling resistor R3 is 100  to
make 1 mA/V of input signal.
VIN (V )
1 kΩ
AD629
380k6
3
The AD629, a difference amplifier with very high
common-mode range, is driven by an input signal Pin 3.
Its transfer function is
VOUT = VIN
6
2
380k6
20k6
21.1k6
5
VCM
1
R1
1k6
R2
9k6
R3
0.1k6
IOUT
+15V
VOUT
OP27*
R1
1k6
–15V
GND1
GROUND INTERFERENCE
* REFER TO THE ANALOG DEVICES WEBSITE AT WWW.ANALOG.COM
FOR THE LATEST OP AMP PRODUCTS AND SPECIFICATIONS.
Figure 6-24. Current transmitter.
6-12
GND2
OP27 was chosen because, at a noise gain of 10,
its bandwidth does not compromise the transmitter. Figure 6-25 is the transfer function of the output
voltage VOUT vs. the input voltage VIN. Figure 6-26 is
a demonstration of how well the transmitter rejects
ground noise.
5V
2V
1mV
5ms
5V
TOP: GROUND NOISE 2V/DIV
BOTTOM: VOUT ERROR AT FULL-SCALE 1A/DIV
Figure 6-26. Interference rejection.
High Level ADC Interface
The circuit of Figure 6-27 provides an interface between
large level analog inputs as high as 10 V operating on
dual supplies and a low level, differential input ADC,
operating on a single supply.
HORIZONTAL: INPUT 5V/DIV
VERTICAL: OUTPUT 5mA/DIV
Figure 6-25. Transfer function.
As shown, two AD628 difference amplifiers are
connected in antiphase.The differential output,V1 – V2,
is an attenuated version of the input signal
V1 − V2 =
(VA − VB )
5
5V
7
VB
–IN
+IN
8
1
R4
100k6
A1
AD628
V1 10k6
A2
R2
100k6
VREF
VS
R3
10k6
+IN
VA
–IN
1
8
R2
100k6
3
5V
–VS
2
CFILT
4
6
3
–VS
2
CFILT
RG
3.32k6
AD7450
13.3k6
C
4
6
RG
3.32k6
R3
10k6
5V
ADR431
R1
10k6
A1
R4
100k6
OUT
R1
10k6
VR
VREF
5
10k6
A2
V2
5
REFERENCE
2.5V
VR
PRECISION
OUT REFERENCE
AD628
7
VS
5V
Figure 6-27. This ADC interface circuit attenuates and level shifts a 10 V differential
signal while operating from a single 5 V supply.
6-13
The difference amplifiers reject the common-mode
voltage on inputs VA and VB. The reference voltage,
VR, which the ADR431 develops and the ADC and the
amplifier share, sets the output common-mode voltage.
A single capacitor, C, placed across the CFILT pins lowpass filters the difference signal, V1 – V2. The –3 dB pole
frequency is fP = 1/(40,000    C). The difference
signal is amplified by 1.5. Thus, the total gain of this
circuit is 3/10.
CH1 A SPECTRUM
0
85dBV
400Hz
Figure 6-28 shows a 10 V input signal (top), the signals at
the output of each AD628 (middle), and the differential
output (bottom). The benefits of this configuration go
beyond simply interfacing with the ADC. The circuit
improves specifications such as common-mode rejection
ratio, offset voltage, drift, and noise by a factor of √2
because the errors of each AD628 are not correlated.
Tek RUN: 50k SAMPLES/SEC
12dB/REF –13dBV
Figure 6-29. The circuit in Figure 6-27 has
an 85 dBV SNR.
T
HI RES
T
20V p-p
1
INPUT
20V p-p
T
T
INPUT
20V p-p
SINGLE-ENDED
OUTPUTS
3V p-p
3
200V p-p
DIFFERENTIAL
OUTPUT
6V p-p
M1
80V p-p
1ms/DIV
COMMON-MODE
ERROR OF
DIFFERENTIAL
OUTPUT
COMMON-MODE
ERROR OF
COMMON-MODE
OUTPUT
Figure 6-28. The waveforms show a 10 V
input signal (top), the signals at the output
of each AD628 (middle), and the differential
output (bottom).
Figure 6-30. The common-mode input (top)
measures 20 V p-p. The common-mode error of
the differential output (middle) is 20 V p-p. The
error of the common-mode output (bottom) is
80 V p-p.
The output demonstrates an 85 dB SNR (Figure 6-29).
The two AD628s interface with an AD7450 12-bit,
differential-input ADC. The AD7450 easily rejects
residual common-mode signals at the output of the
difference amplifiers. Figure 6-30 shows the commonmode error at the output of the AD628.
The topmost waveform is a 10 V, common-mode input
signal. The middle waveform, measuring 150 V, is
the common-mode error measured differentially
from the output of the two AD628s. The bottom
waveform, measuring 80 V, is the common-mode
error that results.
6-14
A High Speed noninverting Summing
Amplifier
The schematic in Figure 6-31 is that of a common
summing amplifier with multiple inputs and one singleended output. It is a variation of an inverting amplifier.
Point X is a virtual ground and referred to as a summing
junction. The transfer function for this circuit is
[
]
VO = − ( RF R1) V 1 + ( RF R 2) V 2 + ( RF R 3)V 3
RF
R1
V1
X
I1
IF
I2
R3
V3
I3
Figure 6-31. A traditional summing amplifier.
1
V1
VO = −(V 1 + V 2 + V 3)
Note that if we want the result VO = (V1 + V2 + V3), we
need an additional inverter with gain = –1. Furthermore,
this circuit has many disadvantages, such as a low input
impedance, plus different impedances for positive and
negative inputs. It requires low bandwidth, and highly
matched resistors are needed.
Figure 6-32 is the schematic of a high speed summing
amplifier, which can sum up as many as four input voltages without the need for an inverter to change the sign
of the output. This could prove very useful in audio and
video applications. The circuit contains three, low cost,
high speed instrumentation amplifiers. The first two
interface with input signals, and their total sum is taken
at the third amplifier’s output with respect to ground.
The inputs are very high impedance, and the signal that
appears at the network output is noninverting.
VO
R2
V2
This indicates that the output is a weighted sum of the
inputs, with the weights being determined by the resistance ratio. If all resistances are equal, the circuit yields
the inverted sum of its inputs.
AD8130
8
6
VO1
4
V2
1
5
AD8130
8
6
4
1
V3
AD8130
5
8
6
4
V4
VO2
5
Figure 6-32. A summing circuit with high input impedance.
6-15
VO
Figure 6-33 is the performance photo at 1 MHz.The top
trace is the input signal for all four inputs. The middle
trace is the sum of inputs V1 and V2. The bottom trace
is the output of the system, which is the total sum of all
four inputs.
1
High Voltage Monitor
A high accuracy, high voltage monitor is shown in
Figure 6-35.
+5V
4
7
T
1
2
2
VIN
3
21.11k6
380k6
380k6
AD629*
380k6
6
20k6
3
GND
CH1 1.0V
CH3 1.0V

CH2 1.0V
M 400ns 125MS/s
A CH1 40.0mV
C1 –15V
200pF
4
VOUT
6
OP177*
7
Figure 6-34 demonstrates the high bandwidth of the
system in Figure 6-32. As we can see, the –3 dB point
is about 220 MHz.
2
3
+15V
* REFER TO THE ANALOG DEVICES WEBSITE AT
WWW.ANALOG.COM FOR THE LATEST OP AMP
PRODUCT NUMBERS AND SPECIFICATIONS.
4
Figure 6-35. High voltage monitor.
3
An integrator (OP177) supplies negative feedback around
a difference amplifier (AD629), forcing its output to stay
at 0 V. The voltage divider on the inverting input sets
the common-mode voltage of the difference amplifier
to VIN/20. VOUT, the integrator output and the measurement output, sources the required current to maintain
the common-mode voltage. R1 and C1 compensate the
system to a bandwidth of 200 kHz.
2
1
PS = 5V
0
–1
–2
–3
–4
The transfer function is VOUT = VIN/19. For example, a
400 V p-p input signal will produce a 21 V p-p output.
–5
–6
R1
100k6
5
8.0ns/pt
Figure 6-33. Performance photo of the
circuit in Figure 6-32.
GAIN (dB)
–5V
1
10
100
FREQUENCY (MHz)
1k
Figure 6-34. Frequency response of
summing circuit in Figure 6-32.
6-16
Figure 6-36 shows that the measured system nonlinearity
is less than 20 ppm over the entire 400 V p-p input range.
System noise is about 550 nV/√Hz referred to the input,
or around 2 mV peak noise voltage (10 ppm of full scale)
over a 300 kHz bandwidth.
NONLINEARITY ERROR (ppm)
20
10
Capturing power supply information from remote communications equipment requires precise measurement
of the voltages, sometimes under outdoor temperature
conditions. High common-mode voltage difference
amplifiers have been used to monitor current. However,
these versatile components can also be used as voltage
dividers, enabling remote monitoring of voltage levels
as well.
Figure 6-37 shows a precision monitor using just
two integrated circuits that derives its power from
the –48 V supply. A low cost transistor and Zener
diode combination provide 15 V supply voltage for
the amplifiers.
0
–10
The AD629 IC is a self-contained, high common-mode
voltage difference amplifier. Connected as shown, it
reduces the differential input voltage by approximately
19 V, thus acting as a precision voltage divider. An
additional amplifier is required for loop stability.
–20
–200
equipment failures resulting from surges, brownouts, or
other line faults may not always be detected.
–150
–100
–50
0
VIN (V)
50
100
150
200
Figure 6-36. Nonlinearity vs. VIN.
The output from the OP777AR drives an AD7476
ADC.
PRECISION 48 V BUS MONITOR
Telephone equipment power supplies normally consist
of a 48 V dc power source and an array of batteries. The
batteries provide backup power during ac power line
outages and help regulate the 48 V dc supply voltage.
Although nominally –48 V, the dc voltage on the
telephone lines can vary anywhere from –40 V to –80 V
and is subject to surges and fluctuations. Supply regulation
at the source has little effect on remote voltage levels, and
2N2222 OR
EQUIVALENT
The circuit features several advantages over alternative
solutions. The AD629’s laser-trimmed divider resistors exhibit essentially perfect matching and tracking
over temperature. Linearity errors from –40 V to
–80 V are nearly immeasurable. Figures 6-38 and
6-39 are linearity and temperature drift curves for
this circuit.
VBUS = +14.1V
VBUS = +5V
ADR425
5V REF
15V
1 –REF
NC
2 –IN
+VS
3 +IN
8
COMPENSATION
POLE AMPLIFIER
VBUS = +5V
7
OP777AR
3
OUT 6
7
6
4 –V
S
–39V TO
–79V
VBUS
+REF 5
AD629
2
1nF
4
VBUS
19
VDD CS
VIN
SDATA
CHIP
SELECT
DATA
OUT
AD7476
GND
SCLK
NC = NO CONNECT
CLOCK
IN
Figure 6-37. Precision remote voltage measurement of –48 V power distribution bus.
6-17
HIGH-SIDE CURRENT SENSE WITH A
LOW-SIDE SWITCH
4.5
A typical application for the AD8202 is high-side
measurement of a current through a solenoid for PWM
control of the solenoid opening. Typical applications
include hydraulic transmission control and diesel injection control.
OUTPUT VOLTAGE (V)
4.0
3.5
Two typical circuit configurations are used for this type
of application.
3.0
2.5
2.0
–30
–40
–50
–60
–70
INPUT VOLTAGE (V)
–80
–90
Figure 6-38. Output vs. input linearity for
the circuit of the 48 V bus monitor.
2.1064
In this circuit configuration, when the switch is closed,
the common-mode voltage moves down to near the
negative rail. When the switch is opened, the voltage
reversal across the inductive load causes the commonmode voltage to be held one diode drop above the battery
by the clamp diode.
2.1062
OUTPUT VOLTAGE (V)
In this case, the PWM control switch is ground referenced.
An inductive load (solenoid) is tied to a power supply. A
resistive shunt is placed between the switch and the load
(see Figure 6-40). An advantage of placing the shunt
on the high side is that the entire current, including the
recirculation current, can be measured, since the shunt
remains in the loop when the switch is off. In addition,
diagnostics can be enhanced because shorts to ground
can be detected with the shunt on the high side.
2.1060
2.1058
2.1056
2.1054
2.1052
2.1050
–50
0
50
TEMPERATURE (C)
100
Figure 6-39. Temperature drift of the
48 V bus monitor.
INDUCTIVE
LOAD
CLAMP
DIODE
OUTPUT
+IN
BATTERY
5V
NC
+VS OUT
14V
4-TERM
SHUNT
AD8202
–IN
GND
A1
A2
POWER
DEVICE
NC = NO CONNECT
COMMON
Figure 6-40. Low-side switch.
6-18
HIGH-SIDE CURRENT SENSE WITH A
HIGH-SIDE SWITCH
This configuration minimizes the possibility of unexpected solenoid activation and excessive corrosion
(see Figure 6-41). In this case, both the switch and the
shunt are on the high side. When the switch is off, this
removes the battery from the load, which prevents damage
from potential shorts to ground while still allowing the
recirculating current to be measured and providing for
diagnostics. Removing the power supply from the load for
the majority of the time minimizes the corrosive effects
that could be caused by the differential voltage between
the load and ground.
When using a high-side switch, the battery voltage
is connected to the load when the switch is closed,
causing the common-mode voltage to increase to the
battery voltage. In this case, when the switch is opened,
the voltage reversal across the inductive load causes the
common-mode voltage to be held one diode drop below
ground by the clamp diode.
POWER
DEVICE
5V
OUTPUT
+IN
BATTERY
NC
+VS OUT
AD8202
–IN
CLAMP
DIODE
COMMON
GND
A1
5V
0.1MF
MOTOR
A2
SHUNT
VREF1
+VS
OUT
AD8210
–IN
GND
VREF2
NC
5V
2.5V
NC = NO CONNECT
Figure 6-42. Motor control application.
The AD8210 measures current in both directions as the
H-bridge switches and the motor changes direction.The
output of the AD8210 is configured in an external
reference bidirectional mode.
BRIDGE APPLICATIONS
A Classic Bridge Circuit
INDUCTIVE
LOAD
NC = NO CONNECT
Figure 6-41. High-side switch.
Motor Control
A typical application for the AD8210 is as part of the
control loop in H-bridge motor control. In this case, the
AD8210 is placed in the middle of the H-bridge (see
Figure 6-42) so that it can accurately measure current in
both directions by using the shunt available at the motor.
Figure 6-43 shows the AD627 configured to amplify the
signal from a classic resistive bridge. This circuit will
work in either dual- or single-supply mode.Typically, the
bridge will be excited by the same voltage used to power
the in-amp. Connecting the bottom of the bridge to the
negative supply of the in-amp (usually either 0, –5 V,
–12 V, or –15 V) sets up an input common-mode voltage
that is optimally located midway between the supply
voltages. It is also appropriate to set the voltage on the
REF pin to midway between the supplies, especially if
the input signal will be bipolar. However, the voltage
+VS
VDIFF
+IN
CONTROLLER
Instrumentation amplifiers are widely used for buffering and amplifying the small voltage output from
transducers that make use of the classic 4-resistor
Wheatstone bridge.
14V
4-TERM
SHUNT
This is a better solution than a ground referenced op
amp because ground is not typically a stable reference
voltage in this type of application. This instability in the
ground reference causes the measurements that could
be made with a simple ground referenced op amp to be
inaccurate.
0.1MF
RG = 200k6
GAIN – 5
AD627
0.1MF
VOUT
VREF
–VS
Figure 6-43. A classic bridge circuit for low power applications.
6-19
on the REF pin can be varied to suit the application.
A good example of this is when the REF pin is tied to
the VREF pin of an analog-to-digital converter (ADC)
whose input range is (VREF  VIN). With an available
output swing on the AD627 of (–VS + 100 mV) to
(+VS – 150 mV), the maximum programmable gain is
simply this output range divided by the input range.
A Single-Supply Data Acquisition System
The bridge circuit of Figure 6-44 is excited by a +5 V
supply. The full-scale output voltage from the bridge
(10 mV), therefore, has a common-mode level of
2.5 V. The AD623 removes the common-mode voltage
component and amplifies the input signal by a factor
of 100 (RGAIN = 1.02 k). This results in an output
signal of 1 V.
In order to prevent this signal from running into the
AD623’s ground rail, the voltage on the REF pin has
to be raised to at least 1 V. In this example, the 2 V
reference voltage from the AD7776 ADC is used to
bias the AD623’s output voltage to 2 V  1 V. This
corresponds to the input range of the ADC.
A Low Dropout Bipolar Bridge Driver
The AD822 can be used for driving a 350  Wheatstone bridge. Figure 6-45 shows one-half of the AD822
being used to buffer the AD589, a 1.235 V low power
reference. The output of +4.5 V can be used to drive an
A/D converter front end. The other half of the AD822
is configured as a unity-gain inverter and generates the
other bridge input of –4.5 V.
Resistors R1 and R2 provide a constant current for
bridge excitation. The AD620 low power instrumentation amplifier is used to condition the differential
output voltage of the bridge. The gain of the AD620
is programmed using an external resistor, RG, and
determined by
G=
49.4 kΩ
+1
RG
+5V
+5V
+5V
0.1F
0.1F
AD7776
10mV
RG
1.02k
AD623
AIN
REF
REFOUT
REFIN
Figure 6-44. A single-supply data acquisition system.
TO A/D CONVERTER
REFERENCE INPUT
+VS
49.9k6
+1.235V
AD589
10k6
1%
R1
206
+
3506
3506
3506
3506
+VS
–
1/2
AD822*
–
AD620
RG
+
10k6
26.4k6, 1%
10k6
1%
* REFER TO THE ANALOG DEVICES WEBSITE AT
WWW.ANALOG.COM FOR THE LATEST OP AMP
PRODUCT NUMBERS AND SPECIFICATIONS.
VREF
1%
+
1/2
AD822
–
–VS
+VS
–4.5V
R2
206
GND
–VS
–VS
Figure 6-45. Low dropout bipolar bridge driver.
6-20
0.1MF
0.1MF
+
+
+
+
1MF
1MF
+5V
–5V
TRANSDUCER INTERFACE APPLICATIONS
Instrumentation amplifiers have long been used as
preamplifiers in transducer applications. High quality
transducers typically provide a highly linear output,
but at a very low level and a characteristically high
output impedance. This requires the use of a high
gain buffer/preamplifier that will not contribute
any discernible noise of its own to that of the signal.
Furthermore, the high output impedance of the typical
transducer may require that the in-amp have a low
input bias current.
Table 6-3 gives typical characteristics for some common
transducer types.
Since most transducers are slow, bandwidth requirements of the in-amp are modest: A 1 MHz small
signal bandwidth at unity gain is adequate for most
applications.
ELECTROCARDIOGRAM SIGNAL
CONDITIONING
The AD8220 makes an excellent input amplifier for
next generation ECGs. Its small size, high CMRR over
frequency, rail-to-rail output, and JFET inputs are
well-suited for this application. Potentials measured
on the skin range from 0.2 mV to 2 mV. The AD8220
solves many of the typical challenges of measuring
these body surface potentials. The AD8220’s high
CMRR helps reject common-mode signals that come
in the form of line noise or high frequency EMI from
equipment in the operating room. Its rail-to-rail output
offers wide dynamic range allowing for higher gains
than would be possible using other instrumentation
amplifiers. JFET inputs offer a large input capacitance of 5 pF. A natural RC filter is formed reducing
high frequency noise when series input resistors are
used in front of the AD8220 (see the RF Interference
section (Reducing RFI Rectification Errors in In-Amp
Circuits), Chapter 5). In addition, the AD8220 JFET
inputs have ultralow input bias current and no current
noise, making it useful for ECG applications where there
are often large impedances. The MSOP package and
the AD8220’s optimal pinout allow smaller footprints
and more efficient layout, paving the way for next
generation portable ECGs.
Figure 6-46 shows an example of an ECG schematic.
Following the AD8220 is a 0.03 Hz, high-pass filter,
formed by the 4.7 mF capacitor and the 1 MV resistor,
which removes the dc offset that develops between the
electrodes. An additional gain of 50, provided by the
AD8618, makes use of the 0 V to 5 V input range of
the ADC. An active, fifth-order, low-pass Bessel filter
removes signals greater than approximately 160 Hz. An
OP2177 buffers, inverts, and gains the common-mode
voltage taken at the midpoint of the AD8220 gain
setting resistors. This right leg drive circuit helps cancel
common-mode signals by inverting the common-mode
signal and driving it back into the body. A 499 kV series
resistor at the output of the OP2177 limits the current
driven into the body.
6-21
6-22
15k6
2.2pF
10k6
10pF
10k6
2.2pF
24.9k6
C
–5V
A
B
–5V
+5V 24.9k6
+5V
499k6
OP2177
4.12k6
–5V
+5V
OP2177
12.7k6
2.5V
1M6
14k6
5006
REF
+5V
4.7MF
REFERENCE
ADR435
ADC
AD7685
2.5V
22nF
+5V
AD8618
68nF
14.5k6
14.5k6
2.7nF
4.99k6
1.15k6
+5V
AD8618
33nF
2.5V
33nF
19.3k6
19.3k6
AD8618
+5V
47nF
14k6
LOW-PASS FIFTH-ORDER FILTER AT 157Hz
2.5V
AD8618
+5V
57.6k6
G = +50
Figure 6-46. An example of an ECG schematic.
866k6
68pF
–5V
+5V
–5V
220pF
4.7MF
INSTRUMENTATION
AMPLIFIER
1.18k6
G = +14
2.5V
HIGH-PASS
AD8220
FILTER 0.033Hz
+5V
Table 6-3. Typical Transducer Characteristics
Transducer Type
Type of Output
Output Z
Recommended
ADI In-Amp/Diff Amp
ThermistorResistance changes
50  to 1 M
with temperature (–TC),
@ +25C
4%/C @ +25C,
high nonlinear output,
single-supply
ThermocoupleLow source Z,
20  to 20 k
10 V/C to 100 V/C,
(10  typ)
mV output level
@ +25C single-supply
Resistance TemperatureLow source Z
20  to 20 k
Detector (RTD)
with temperature (+TC),
@ 0C
(In Bridge Circuit)
0.1%/C to 0.66%/C,
single- or dual-supply
Level Sensors
Thermistor output (low),
500  to 2 k
Thermal Types
variable resistance,
100  to 2 k
Float Types
output of mV to several volts,
single-supply
Load Cell
Variable resistance,
120  to 1 k
(Strain Gage Bridge)
2 mV/V of excitation,
(Weight Measurement) 0.1% typical full-scale change,
single- or dual-supply
Current Sense (Shunt)Low value resistor output,
A few ohms
high common-mode voltage
(or less)
EKG MonitorsLow level differential,
500 k
(Single-Supply
output voltage,
Bridge Configuration) 5 mV output typical,
single- or dual-supply
AD620, AD621, AD623,
AD627, AD629, AD8221,
AD8225
Photodiode SensorCurrent increases
109 
with light intensity,
1 pA to 1 A IOUTPUT,
single-supply
Hall Effect Magnetic
5 mV/kg to 120 mV/kg
1  to 1 k
6-23
AD620, AD621, AD623,
AD627, AD8221, AD8222,
AD8230
AD620, AD621, AD623,
AD627, AD8221, AD8225,
AD8230, AD8250, AD8251,
AD8555, AD8556
AD626, AD628, AD629,
AD8225, AD8553
AD620, AD621, AD8221,
AD8222, AD8225, AD8230,
AD8555, AD8556
AD626, AD628, AD629,
AD8202, AD8205
AD620, AD621, AD623,
AD627, AD8220, AD8221,
AD8222, AD8225, AD8553
AD620, AD621, AD622,
AD623, AD627, AD8220,
AD8221, AD8222, AD8555
AD620, AD621, AD622,
AD623, AD627, AD8221,
AD8222, AD8230, AD8250, AD8251
Three in-amps are used to provide three separate outputs for monitoring the patient’s condition. Suitable
ADI products include AD8221, AD627, and AD623
in-amps and AD8641, AD8642 (dual), and AD8643
(quad) op amps for use as the buffer. Each in-amp is
followed by a high-pass filter that removes the dc component from the signal. It is common practice to omit
one of the in-amps and determine the third output by
software (or hardware) calculation.
25 k resistors, but any net capacitance between the
twisted pairs and ground needs to be minimized to
maintain stability. So, unshielded twisted pair cable is
recommended for this circuit. For low speed applications that require driving long lengths of shielded cable,
the AMP01 should be substituted for the AMP03
device. The AMP01 can drive capacitance loads up
to 1 F, while the AMP03 is limited to driving a few
hundred pF.
Proper safeguards, such as isolation, must be added to
this circuit to protect the patient from possible harm.
A PRECISION VOLTAGE-TO-CURRENT
CONVERTER
REMOTE LOAD-SENSING TECHNIQUE
Figure 6-48 is a precision voltage-to-current converter
whose scale factor is easily programmed for exact decade
ratios using standard 1% metal film resistor values.
The AD620 operates with full accuracy on standard
5 V power supply voltages. Note that although the
quiescent current of the AD620 is only 900 A, the
addition of the AD705 will add an additional 380 A
current consumption.
The circuit of Figure 6-47 is a unity-gain instrumentation
amplifier that uses its sense and reference pins to minimize any errors due to parasitic voltage drops within the
circuit. If heavy output currents are expected, and there
is a need to sense a load that is some distance away from
the circuit, voltage drops due to trace or wire resistance
can cause errors. These voltage drops are particularly
troublesome with low resistance loads, such as 50 .
A CURRENT SENSOR INTERFACE
Figure 6-49 shows a novel circuit for sensing low level
currents. It makes use of the large common-mode range of
the AD626.The current being measured is sensed across
resistor RS. The value of RS should be less than 1 k
and should be selected so that the average differential
voltage across this resistor is typically 100 mV.
The sense terminal completes the feedback path for the
instrumentation amplifier output stage and is normally
connected directly to the in-amp output. Similarly, the
reference terminal sets the reference voltage about which
the in-amp’s output will swing. This connection puts
the IR drops inside the feedback loop of the in-amp
and virtually eliminates any IR errors.
To produce a full-scale output of +4 V, a gain of 40 is
used, adjustable by +20% to absorb the tolerance in the
sense resistor. Note that there is sufficient headroom to
allow at least a 10% overrange (to +4.4 V).
This circuit will provide a 3 dB bandwidth better than
3 MHz. Note that any net capacitance between the
twisted pairs is isolated from the in-amp’s output by
+VIN
–IN
2
25k6
25k6
5
SENSE
7 +VCC
AMP03
6
4
–VIN
+IN
25k6
3
25k6
1
TWISTED
PAIRS
*
OUTPUT
REMOTE
LOAD
–VEE
REFERENCE
TWISTED
PAIRS
*
OUTPUT
GROUND
*1N4148 DIODES ARE OPTIONAL. DIODES LIMIT THE OUTPUT
VOLTAGE EXCURSION IF SENSE AND/OR REFERENCE LINES
BECOME DISCONNECTED FROM THE LOAD.
Figure 6-47. A remote load sensing connection.
6-24
+VS
VIN+
0.1MF
7
3
8
+ VX –
AD620
RG
1
VIN–
6
5
2
4
I L=
Vx
R1
=
[(V IN+) – (V IN– )] G
7
2
IL
AD705*
4
–VS
0.1MF
R1
+VS
6
–VS
R1
0.1MF
49,400
WHERE G = 1 +
RG
3
0.1MF
LOAD
* REFER TO THE ANALOG DEVICES WEBSITE AT WWW.ANALOG.COM
FOR THE LATEST OP AMP PRODUCT NUMBERS AND SPECIFICATIONS.
Figure 6-48. A precision voltage-to-current converter that operates on 5 V supplies.
CURRENT IN
CURRENT
SENSOR
CURRENT OUT
RS
1
2
–VS
3
200k6
–IN
ANALOG
GND
8
1/6
G = 100
G = 30
RS
7
+VS 6
–VS
0.1MF
CF
OPTIONAL
LOW-PASS
FILTER
200k6 +IN
+VS
100k6
4
0.1MF
FILTER
OUT
G=2
OUTPUT
5
AD626
Figure 6-49. Current sensor interface.
OUTPUT BUFFERING, LOW POWER IN-AMPS
+VS
The AD627 low power in-amp is designed to drive load
impedances of 20 k or higher, but can deliver up to
20 mA to heavier loads with low output voltage swings.
If more than 20 mA of output current is required, the
AD627’s output should be buffered with a precision
low power op amp, such as the AD820, as shown in
Figure 6-50. This op amp can swing from 0 V to 4 V
on its output while driving a load as small as 600 .
The addition of the AD820 isolates the in-amp from the
load, thus greatly reducing any thermal effects.
0.1MF
3
7
0.1MF
1
AD627
RG
8
2
6
3
5
REF
2
4
0.1MF
–VS
7
AD820*
4
6
VOUT
0.1MF
–VS
* REFER TO THE ANALOG DEVICES WEBSITE AT
WWW.ANALOG.COM FOR THE LATEST OP AMP
PRODUCT NUMBERS AND SPECIFICATIONS.
Figure 6-50. Output buffer for low power in-amps.
6-25
A 4 TO 20 mA SINGLE-SUPPLY RECEIVER
Figure 6-51 shows how a signal from a 4 to 20 mA
transducer can be interfaced to the ADuC812, a 12-bit
ADC with an embedded microcontroller.The signal from
a 4 to 20 mA transducer is single-ended. This initially
suggests the need for a simple shunt resistor to convert
the current to a voltage at the high impedance analog
input of the converter. However, any line resistance in
the return path (to the transducer) will add a currentdependent offset error. So, the current must be sensed
differentially. In this example, a 24.9  shunt resistor
generates a maximum differential input voltage to the
AD627 of between 100 mV (for 4 mA in) and 500 mV
(for 20 mA in).With no gain resistor present, the AD627
amplifies the 500 mV input voltage by a factor of 5 to
2.5 V, the full-scale input voltage of the ADC. The zero
current of 4 mA corresponds to a code of 819, and the
LSB size is 0.61 mV.
A SINGLE-SUPPLY THERMOCOUPLE
AMPLIFIER
Because the common-mode input range of the AD627
extends 0.1 V below ground, it is possible to measure
small differential signals with little or no commonmode component. Figure 6-52 shows a thermocouple
application where one side of the J-type thermocouple
is grounded. Over a temperature range from –200C
to +200C, the J-type thermocouple delivers a voltage
ranging from –7.890 mV to +10.777 mV.
A programmed gain on the AD627 of 100 (RG = 2.1 k)
and a voltage on the AD627 REF pin of 2 V results in
the AD627’s output voltage ranging from 1.110 V to
3.077 V relative to ground.
SPECIALTY PRODUCTS
Analog Devices sells a number of specialty products,
many of which were designed for the audio market that
are useful for some in-amp applications. Table 6-4 lists
some of these products.
+5V
+5V
+5V
0.1 F
3
1
4 TO 20mA
TRANSDUCER
LINE
IMPEDANCE
4 TO 20mA
24.9
7
0.1 F
8
2
4
G=5
AVDD
VREF
6
AD627
RG
0.1 F
ADuC812
MICROCONVERTER™
AIN 0–7
5
AGND
REF
DVDD
DGND
Figure 6-51. A 4 to 20 mA receiver circuit.
+5V
COLD JUNCTION
COMPENSATION
0.1F
3
1
J-TYPE
THERMOCOUPLE
AD627
RG
8
2
THERMOCOUPLE
WIRES
7
6
5 REF
4
VOUT
+2V
COPPER
WIRES
Figure 6-52. A thermocouple amplifier using a low power, single-supply in-amp.
Table 6-4. Specialty Products Available from Analog Devices
Part
Number Description
BW
SSM2141 Diff line receiver
SSM2143 Diff line receiver
SSM2019 Audio preamp
CMR
(DC)
Supply
Features
3 MHz
100 dB 18 V
High CMR, audio subtractor
7 MHz (G = 0.5) 90 dB 6 V to 18 VLow distortion, audio subtractor
2 MHz (G = 1) 74 dB 5 V to 18 VLow noise, low distortion, audio IA
6-26
Chapter VII
MATCHING IN-AMP CIRCUITS TO MODERN ADCs
Calculating ADC Requirements
The resolution of commercial ADCs is specified in bits.
In an ADC, the available resolution equals (2n) – 1, where
n is the number of bits. For example, an 8-bit converter
provides a resolution of (28) – 1, which equals 255. In this
case, the full-scale input range of the converter divided
by 255 will equal the smallest signal it can resolve. For
example, an 8-bit ADC with a 5 V full-scale input range
will have a limiting resolution of 19.6 mV.
In selecting an appropriate ADC to use, we need to find
a device that has a resolution better than the measurement resolution but, for economy’s sake, not a great
deal better.
Table 7-1 provides input resolution and full-scale input
range using an ADC with or without an in-amp preamplifier. Note that the system resolution specified in the figure
refers to that provided by the converter together with the
in-amp preamp (if used). Also, note that for any low level
measurement, not only are low noise semiconductor devices
needed, but also careful attention to component layout,
grounding, power supply bypassing, and often, the use of
balanced, shielded inputs.
For many applications, an 8-bit or 10-bit converter
is appropriate. The decision to use a high resolution
converter alone, or to use a gain stage ahead of a
lower resolution converter, depends on which is more
important: component cost, or parts count and ease
of assembly.
One very effective way to raise system resolution is to
amplify the signal first, to allow full use of the dynamic
range of the ADC. However, this added gain ahead of the
converter will also increase noise. Therefore, it is often
useful to add low-pass filtering between the output of an
in-amp (or other gain stage) and the input of the converter.
Also, in most cases, the system bandwidth should not be
set higher than that required to accurately measure the
signal of interest. A good rule of thumb is to set the –3 dB
corner frequency of the low-pass filter at 10 to 20 times
the highest frequency that will be measured.
Adding amplification before the ADC will also reduce
the circuit’s full-scale input range, but it will lower the
resolution requirements (and, therefore, the cost) of
the ADC (see Figure 7-1).
For example, using an in-amp with a gain of 10 ahead of
an 8-bit, 5 V ADC will increase circuit resolution from
19.5 mV (5 V/256) to 1.95 mV. At the same time, the
full-scale input range of the circuit will be reduced to
500 mV (5 V/10).
Table 7-1. Typical System Resolutions vs. Converter Resolution and Preamp (IA) Gain
Converter Type
(2n) – 1
Converter Resolution
System
mV/Bit
In-Amp
FS Range Resolution
(5 V/((2n) – 1)) Gain
(V p-p)
(mV p-p)
10-Bit
10-Bit
10-Bit
10-Bit
12-Bit
12-Bit
12-Bit
12-Bit
14-Bit
14-Bit
14-Bit
14-Bit
16-Bit
16-Bit
16-Bit
16-Bit
4.9 mV
4.9 mV
4.9 mV
4.9 mV
1.2 mV
1.2 mV
1.2 mV
1.2 mV
0.305 mV
0.305 mV
0.305 mV
0.305 mV
0.076 mV
0.076 mV
0.076 mV
0.076 mV
1023
1023
1023
1023
4095
4095
4095
4095
16,383
16,383
16,383
16,383
65,535
65,535
65,535
65,535
1
2
5
10
1
2
5
10
1
2
5
10
1
2
5
10
7-1
5
2.5
1
0.5
5
2.5
1
0.5
5
2.5
1
0.5
5
2.5
1
0.5
4.9
2.45
0.98
0.49
1.2
0.6
0.24
0.12
0.305
0.153
0.061
0.031
0.076
0.038
0.015
0.008
Matching ADI In-Amps with Some Popular ADCs
Table 7-2 shows recommended ADCs for use with the latest generation of ADI in-amps.
Table 7-2. Recommended ADCs for Use with ADI In-Amps
ADI In-Amp
AD8221AR
ADI In-Amp
AD620AR
Small Signal BW:
Noise (eNI):
VOS:
In-Amp Gain:
Maximum Output
Voltage Swing:
CMR:
Nonlinearity:
Supply Voltage:
Supply Current:
0.01% Settling Time
for 5 V Step:
0.001% Settling Time
for 5 V Step:
562 kHz
8 nV/√Hz
60 V max
10
Small Signal BW:
Noise (eNI): VOS:
In-Amp Gain: Maximum Output
Voltage Swing: CMR: Nonlinearity: Supply Voltage:
Supply Current: 0.01% Settling Time
for 5 V Step: 800 kHz
9 nV/√Hz
125 V max
10
3.9 V
90 dB (dc to 60 Hz)
10 ppm max
5 V
1 mA max
5 s
6 s
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7685, AD7687
Resolution:
16 bits
Input Range:
0 V to 5 V
Sampling Rate:
Up to 250 kSPS
S/D Supply:
3 V or 5 V
Power:
1.7 mW @ 2.5 V and
6 mW typ @ 5 V
Comments:
Same package, the AD7685 can be driven through a simple RC from the AD8221 directly. The REF pin can be driven to fit the ADC range.
Recommended ADI ADC#2
AD7453/AD7457
Resolution:
12 bits
Input Range:
0 V to VDD
Sampling Rate:
555 kSPS/100 kSPS
S/D Supply:
3 V or 5 V
Power:
0.3 mA @ 100 kSPS
Comments:
Single channel, pseudo
differential inputs in a
SOT-23 package
7-2
3.9 V
73 dB (dc to 60 Hz)
40 ppm max
5 V
1.3 mA max
7 s
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7610, AD7663
Resolution:
16 bits
Input Range:
Multiple, such as 10 V,
5 V, ...
Sampling Rate:
Up to 250 kSPS
S/D Supply:
5V
Power:
2.7 mA @ 100 kSPS
Comments:
Allow more and larger
input ranges
Recommended ADI ADC#2
AD7895
Resolution:
12 bits
Input Range:
Multiple, such as 10 V, 2.5 V, 0 V to 2.5 V
Sampling Rate:
200 kSPS
S/D Supply:
5V
Power:
2.2 mA @ 100 kSPS
Comments:
Allows a bipolar or unipolar input with a single supply
Table 7-2. Recommended ADCs for Use with ADI
In-Amps (continued)
ADI In-Amp
AD8225 Fixed Gain of 5
Small Signal BW:
Noise (eNI):
VOS:
In-Amp Gain:
Maximum Output
Voltage Swing: CMR: Nonlinearity: Supply Voltage: Supply Current:
0.01% Settling Time
for 5 V Step:
0.001% Settling Time
for 5 V Step:
900 kHz
8 nV/√Hz
125 V max
5
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7866
Resolution:
12 bits
Input Range:
0 V to VREF V or 0 V to
2  VREF V
Sampling Rate:
1 MSPS for both ADCs
S/D Supply:
Single, 2.7 V to 5.25 V
Power:
24 mW max at 1 MSPS with 5 V supply 11.4 mW max at
1 MSPS with 3 V supply
Comments:
Dual, 2-channel, simultaneous sampling ADC with a serial interface
4 V
90 dB (dc to 60 Hz)
10 ppm max
5 V
1.2 mA max
3.2 s
Recommended ADI ADC#2
AD7862/AD7864
Resolution:
12 bits
Input Range:
0 V to +2.5 V, 0 V to +5 V,
2.5 V, 5 V, 10 V
Sampling Rate:
600 kSPS for one channel
S/D Supply:
Single, 5 V
Power:
90 mW typ
Comments:
4-channel, simultaneous sampling ADC with a
parallel interface
4 s
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7661
Resolution:
16 bits
Input Range:
0 V to 2.5 V
Sampling Rate:
Up to 100 kSPS
S/D Supply:
5V
Power:
8 mA @ 100 kSPS with
reference
Comments:
Provide a reference voltage
Recommended ADI ADC#3
AD7863/AD7865
Resolution:
14 bits
Input Range:
0 V to +2.5 V, 0 V to +5 V,
2.5 V, 5 V, 10 V
Sampling Rate:
175 kSPS for both channels/
360 kSPS for one channel, respectively
S/D Supply:
Single, 5 V
Power:
70 mW typ/115 mV typ,
respectively
Comments:
2-/4-channel, respectively, simultaneous sampling ADC with a parallel interface
Recommended ADI ADC#2
AD7940
Resolution:
14 bits
Input Range:
0 V to VDD
Sampling Rate:
100 kSPS
S/D Supply:
3 V or 5 V
Power:
0.83 mA @ 100 kSPS
Comments:
Single channel in an SOT-23
ADI In-Amp
AD623AR
Small Signal BW:
Noise (eNI):
VOS:
In-Amp Gain: Maximum Output
Voltage Swing:
CMR:
Nonlinearity:
Supply Voltage: Supply Current:
0.01% Settling Time
for 5 V Step:
100 kHz
35 nV/√Hz
200 V max
10
Recommended ADI ADC#4
AD7890/AD7891/AD7892
Resolution:
12 bits
Input Range:
0 V to +2.5 V, 0 V to
+4.096 V, 0 V to +5 V,
2.5 V, 5 V10 V
Sampling Rate:
117/500/600 kSPS, respectively
S/D Supply:
Single, 5 V
Power:
30/85/60 mW typ, respectively
Comments:
8-/8-/1-channel, respectively
4.5 V
90 dB (dc to 60 Hz)
50 ppm typ
5 V
0.55 mA max
20 s
7-3
Table 7-2. Recommended ADCs for Use with ADI
In-Amps (continued)
ADI In-Amp
AD627AR
Small Signal BW:
Noise (eNI):
VOS:
In-Amp Gain: Maximum Output
Voltage Swing: CMR: Nonlinearity: Supply Voltage: Supply Current: 0.01% Settling Time
for 5 V Step: 30 kHz
38 nV/√Hz
200 V max
10
4.9 V
77 dB (dc to 60 Hz)
100 ppm max
5 V
85 A max
135 s
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7923/AD7927
Resolution:
12 bits
Input Range:
0 V to VREF or 0 V to
2  VREF
Sampling Rate:
200 kSPS
S/D Supply:
Single, 2.7 V to 5.25 V
Power:
3.6 mW max @ 200 kSPS with a 3 V supply
Comments:
8-/4-channel ADCs,
respectively, with a serial interface and channel
sequencer
ADI In-Amp JFET In-Amp
AD8220AR
Small Signal BW: Noise (eNI): VOS: In-Amp Gain: Maximum Output
Voltage Swing: CMRR: Nonlinearity: Supply Voltage: Supply Current: 0.01% Settling Time
for 5 V step: 1000 kHz
15 nV/√Hz
1 mV max
10
64.8 V
110 dB (dc to 60 Hz)
10 ppm max
Dual, 65 V
1 mA max
5 ms
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7610/AD7663
Resolution: 16 bits
62.5 V, 65 V, 610 V
Input Range: Sampling Rate:
250 kSPS for both ADCs
65 V to 615 V and 5 V
S/D Supply: Recommended ADI ADC#2
AD7920
Resolution:
12 bits
Input Range:
0 to VDD
Sampling Rate:
250 kSPS
S/D Supply:
2.35 V or 5.25 V
Power:
3 mW typ @ 250 kSPS with 3 V supply
Comments:
Single channel, serial ADC in
6-lead SC70
7-4
Recommended ADC#2
AD7321, AD7323, and AD7327
Resolution:
13 bits
62.5 V, 65 V, 610 V
Input Range:
Sampling Rate:
500 kSPS
65 V to 615 V and +5 V
S/D Supply:
Power:
17 mW max at 0.5 MSPS with 615 V, and 5 V supply
Recommended ADI ADC#3
AD7898-3
Resolution:
12 bits
62.5 V
Input Range:
Sampling Rate:
220 kSPS
S/D Supply:
5V
Power:
22.5 mW max at 220 kSPS with 5 V supply
Table 7-2. Recommended ADCs for Use with ADI
In-Amps (continued)
ADI In-Amp
Zero Drift In-Amp
AD8230RZ
ADI In-Amp AD8250/AD8251
High Speed Programmable Gain In-Amp
Small Signal BW: Noise (eNI): VOS: In-Amp Gain: Maximum Output
Voltage Swing: CMRR: Nonlinearity: Supply Voltage: Supply Current: 2 kHz
240 nV/√Hz
10 mV max
10
Small Signal BW: Noise (eNI): VOS: In-Amp Gain: Maximum Output
Voltage Swing: CMRR: Nonlinearity: Supply Voltage: Supply Current: 0.01% Settling Time
for 5 V step: 64.7 V
120 dB (dc to 60 Hz)
20 ppm max
65 V
3.5 mA max
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7942
Resolution: 14 bits
Input Range: 5V
Sampling Rate: 250 kSPS
S/D Supply: 2.7 V to 5.25 V
Power: 1.25 mW, 2.5 V supply
10 MHz
13 nV/√Hz
100 mV
10
VCC – 1.2 V, VCC + 1.2 V
100 dB (dc to 60 Hz)
40 ppm max
Dual, 65 V to 612 V
3 mA typ
0.5 ms
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7685, AD7687
Resolution: 16 bits
Input Range: 5V
Sampling Rate: 250 kSPS
S/D Supply: Single, 2.5 V to 5 V
Power: 4 mW at 0.1 kSPS, 5 V supply
Recommended ADI ADC#2
AD7321
Resolution: 13 bits
62.5 V
Input Range: Sampling Rate: 500 kSPS
65 V to 615 V,
S/D Supply: 2.7 V to 5.25 V
Power: 17 mW max at 500 kSPS with 615 V, 5 V supply
Recommended ADI ADC#2
AD7327, AD7323, and AD7321
Resolution: 13 bits/12 bits
62.5 V
Input Range: Sampling Rate: 0.5 MSPS
65 V to 615 V, single, 5 V
S/D Supply: Power: 17 mW max at 500 kSPS with 615 V, 5 V supply
NOTE: Specifications are preliminary. Refer to www.analog.com.
7-5
Table 7-2. Recommended ADCs for Use with ADI
In-Amps (continued)
ADI In-Amp Zero Drift In-Amp
AD8553RM
ADI In-Amp Zero Drift In-Amp
AD8555AR/AD8556ARZ
Small Signal BW: Noise (eNI): VOS: In-Amp Gain: Maximum Output
Voltage Swing: CMRR: Nonlinearity: Supply Voltage: Supply Current: 1 kHz
150 nV/√Hz
50 mV max
10
Small Signal BW: Noise (eNI): VOS: In-Amp Gain: Maximum Output
Voltage Swing: CMRR: Nonlinearity: Supply Voltage: Supply Current: 0.1% Settling Time
for 4 V step: 150 kHz
32 nV√Hz
10 mV max
10
0.075 V to 4.925 V
120 dB (dc to 60 Hz)
600 ppm max
Single, 5 V
1.3 mA max
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7476
Resolution:
12 bits
Input Range: 0 to VDD
Sampling Rate: 1 MSPS
S/D Supply: 2.35 V to 5.25 V
Power: 3.6 mW max at 1 MSPS with 3 V supply
15 mW max at 1 MSPS
with 5 V supply
30 mV to 4.94 V
100 dB (G = 70, dc
to 200 Hz)
1000 ppm typ
Single, 5 V
2.5 mA max
8 ms
Recommended ADI ADC#1
AD7685
Resolution: 16 bits
Input Range: 5V
Sampling Rate: 250 kSPS
S/D Supply: Single, 2.5 V to 5 V
Power: 4 mW at 0.1 SPS with
5 V supply
Recommended ADI ADC#2
AD7466
Resolution: 12 bits
Input Range: 0 to VDD
Sampling Rate:
100 kSPS
S/D Supply: 1.6 V to 3.6 V
Power: 0.62 mW max at 100 kSPS with 3 V supply
0.12 mW max at 100 kSPS with 1.6 V supply
Recommended ADI ADC#2
AD7476
Resolution: 12 bits
Input Range: 0 to VDD
Sampling Rate: 1 MSPS
S/D Supply: 2.35 V to 5.25 V
Power: 3.6 mW max at 1 MSPS with 3 V supply
15 mW max at 1 MSPS
with 5 V supply
Recommended ADI ADC#3
AD7476A
Resolution: 12 bits
Input Range: 0 to VDD
Sampling Rate: 1 MSPS
S/D Supply: 2.7 V to 5.25 V
Power: 3.6 mW max at 1 MSPS with 3 V supply
12.5 mW max at 1 MSPS with 5 V supply
7-6
PIXEL
#2
PIXEL
#1
PIXEL LEVEL
REFERENCE
LEVEL
INSTRUMENTATION
AMPLIFIER
PIXEL LEVEL
INPUT
NEED 12-BIT
SAMPLEAND-HOLD ACCURACY
@1MHz
REFERENCE
LEVEL INPUT
2MHz
500ns
ADC
DC
CORRECTED
OUTPUT
AD7266,
AD7322,
ETC.
TOTAL SETTLING TIME FOR SAMPLE-AND-HOLD
AND IN-AMP MUST BE LESS THAN 500ns
Figure 7-1. In-amp buffers ADC and provides dc correction.
High Speed Data Acquisition
As the speed and accuracy of modern data acquisition systems have increased, a growing need for high
bandwidth instrumentation amplifiers has developed—
particularly in the field of CCD imaging equipment
where offset correction and input buffering are required.
Here, double-correlated sampling techniques are often
used for offset correction of the CCD imager. As shown
in Figure 7-1, two sample-and-hold amplifiers monitor the pixel and reference levels, and a dc-corrected
output is provided by feeding their signals into an
instrumentation amplifier.
Figure 7-2 shows how a single multiplexed high
bandwidth in-amp can replace several slow speed
nonmultiplexed buffers. The system benefits from
the common-mode noise reduction and subsequent
increase in dynamic range provided by the in-amp.
HIGH SPEED IA
SIGNAL
INPUTS
MUX
ADC
SIGNAL
INPUTS
MUX
AD7266,
AD7322,
ETC.
Figure 7-2. Single high speed in-amp and
mux replace several slow speed buffers.
Previously, the low bandwidths of commonly available
instrumentation amplifiers, plus their inability to
drive 50  loads, restricted their use to low frequency
applications—generally below 1 MHz. Some higher
bandwidth amplifiers have been available, but these
have been fixed-gain types with internal resistors. With
these amplifiers, there was no access to the inverting and
noninverting terminals of the amplifier. Using modern
op amps and employing the complementary bipolar
(CB) process, video bandwidth instrumentation amplifiers that offer both high bandwidths and impressive dc
specifications may now be constructed. Common-mode
rejection may be optimized by trimming or by using
low cost resistor arrays.
7-7
The bandwidth and settling time requirements demanded of an in-amp buffering an ADC, and for the
sample-and-hold function preceding it, can be quite
severe. The input buffer must pass the signal along
fast enough so that the signal is fully settled before
the ADC takes its next sample. At least two samples
per cycle are required for an ADC to unambiguously
process an input signal (FS/2)—this is referred to as
the Nyquist criteria. Therefore, a 2 MHz ADC, such as
the AD7266 or AD7322, requires that the input buffer/sample-and-hold sections preceding it provide
12-bit accuracy at a 1 MHz bandwidth. Settling time
is equally important: the sampling rate of an ADC is
the inverse of its sampling frequency—for the 2 MHz
ADC, the sampling rate is 500 ns. This means that
for a total throughput rate of less than 1 s, these
same input buffer/sample-and-hold sections must
have a total settling time of less than 500 ns.
and high speed at moderate gains. Circuit gain is set by
resistor RG where gain = 1 + 2 R F /RG. The R F resistors
should be kept at around 1 k to ensure maximum
bandwidth. Operating at a gain of 10 (using a 222 
resistor for RG ) the –3 dB bandwidth of this circuit
is approximately 3.4 MHz. The ac common-mode
rejection ratio (gain of 10, 1 V p-p common-mode
signal applied to the inputs) is 60 dB from 1 Hz
to 200 kHz and 43 dB at 2 MHz. And it provides
better than 46 dB CMRR from 4 MHz to 7 MHz.
The RFI rejection characteristics of this amplifier are
also excellent—the change in dc offset voltage vs.
common-mode frequency is better than 80 dB from
1 Hz up to 15 MHz. Quiescent supply current for this
circuit is 15 mA.
A High Speed In-Amp Circuit for Data Acquisition
This circuit can be used to drive a modern, high speed
ADC such as the AD871 or AD9240, and to provide
very high speed data acquisition. The AD830 can also
be used for many high speed applications.
Figure 7-3 shows a discrete in-amp circuit using two
AD825 op amps and an AMP03 differential (subtractor)
amplifier. This design provides both high performance
For lower speed applications requiring a low input
current device, the AD823 FET input op amp can be
substituted for the AD825.
+VS 0.01MF
–VIN
AD825*
VOUT
0.01MF
–IN
RF
25k6
2
25k6
7
+VIN
RG
222k6
RF
1k6
AMP03
6
0.01MF
AD825*
SENSE
1k6
–VS
+VS
5
4
+IN
3
25k6
25k6
1
+VS
OUTPUT
–VS
REF
0.01MF
–VS
* REFER TO ANALOG DEVICES WEBSITE AT WWW.ANALOG.COM FOR THE LATEST OP AMP
PRODUCTS AND SPECIFICATIONS.
Figure 7-3. A High performance, high speed in-amp circuit.
7-8
ADC
Appendix A
INSTRUMENTATION AMPLIFIER SPECIFICATIONS
To successfully apply any electronic component, a full
understanding of its specifications is required. That is to
say, the numbers contained in a data sheet are of little
value if the user does not have a clear picture of what
each specification means.
In this section, a typical monolithic instrumentation
amplifier data sheet is reviewed. Some of the more
important specifications are discussed in terms of how
they are measured and what errors they might contribute
to the overall performance of the circuit.
Table A-1 shows a portion of the data sheet for the Analog
Devices AD8221 instrumentation amplifier.
Table A-1. AD8221 Specifications1
A
Parameter
Conditions
Min
AR Grade
Typ
Max
Min
BR Grade
Typ
Max
ARM Grade
Min
Typ Max Unit
B COMMON-MODE
REJECTION RATIO (CMRR)
CMRR DC to 60 Hz with
VCM = –10 V to +10 V
1 k Source Imbalance
G = 1
80
90
80
G = 10
100
110
100
G = 100
120
130
120
G = 1000
130
140
130
VCM = –10 V to +10 V
C CMRR at 10 kHz G = 1
80
80
80
G = 10
90
100
90
G = 100
100
110
100
G = 1000
100
110
100
RTI noise = √eNI2 + (eNO/G)2
NOISE
Voltage Noise, 1 kHz
VIN+, VIN–, VREF = 0
8
8
8
Input Voltage Noise, eNI
75
75
75
Output Voltage Noise, eNO
RTI
f = 0.1 Hz to 10 Hz
G = 1
2
2
2
G = 10
0.5
0.5
0.5
G = 100 to 1000
0.25
0.25
0.25
Current Noise
f = 1 kHz
40
40
40
f = 0.1 Hz to 10 Hz
6
6
6
D VOLTAGE OFFSET2 VS = 5 V to 15 V
60
25
70
Input Offset, VOSI
86
45
135
Over Temperature
T = –40C to +85C
Average TC
0.4
0.3
0.9
VS = 5 V to 15 V
300
200
600
Output Offset, VOSO
0.66
0.45
1.00
Over Temperature
T = –40C to +85C
Average TC
6
5
9
Offset RTI vs. Supply (PSR) VS = 2.3 V to 18 V
G = 1
90
110
94
110
90
100
G = 10
110
120
114
130
100
120
G = 100
124
130
130
140
120
140
G = 1000
130
140
140
150
120
140
E INPUT CURRENT
Input Bias Current
0.5
1.5
0.2
0.4
0.5
2
2.0
1
3
Over Temperature
T = –40C to +85C
Average TC
1
1
3
Input Offset Current
0.2
0.6
0.1
0.4
0.3
1
0.8
0.6
1.5
Over Temperature
T = –40C to +85C
Average TC
1
1
3
A-1
dB
dB
dB
dB
dB
dB
dB
dB
nV/√Hz
nV/√Hz
µV p-p
µV p-p
µV p-p
fA/√Hz
pA p-p
µV
µV
µV/C
µV
mV
µV/C
dB
dB
dB
dB
nA
nA
pA/C
nA
nA
pA/C
Parameter
Conditions
Min
AR Grade
Typ
Max
H
BR Grade
Typ
Max
Min
ARM Grade
Typ
Max
k
A
V
V/V
POWER SUPPLY
18
2.3
1
0.9
1
1.2
1
Over Temperature
T = –40C to +85C
V
mA
mA
18
2.3
1
0.9
1.2
1
18
1
1.2
DYNAMIC RESPONSE
Small Signal, –3 dB
Bandwidth
G = 1 825
825
825
G = 10
562
562
562
G = 100
100
100
100
G = 1000
14.7
14.7
14.7
Settling Time 0.01%
10 V step
G = 1 to 100
10
10
10
G = 1000
80
80
80
Settling Time 0.001%
10 V step
G = 1 to 100
13
13
13
G = 1000
110
110
110
Slew Rate
G = 1
1.5
1.7
1.5
1.7
1.5
1.7
G = 5 to 100
2
2.5
2
2.5
2
2.5
I GAIN
G = 1 + (49.4 k/RG)
J Gain Range
1
1000
1
1000
1
1000
VOUT 10 V
K Gain Error
G = 1
0.03
0.02
0.1
G = 10
0.3
0.15
0.3
G = 100
0.3
0.15
0.3
G = 1000
0.3
0.15
0.3
VOUT = –10 V to +10 V
L Gain Nonlinearity
3
10
3
10
5
15
G = 1 to 10RL = 10 k
5
15
5
15
7
20
G = 100RL = 10 k
10
40
10
40
10
50
G = 1000RL = 10 k
10
95
10
95
15
100
G = 1 to 100RL = 2 k
M Gain vs. Temperature
G = 1
3
10
2
5
3
10
–50
–50
–50
G > 13
INPUT
Input Impedance
Differential
100 ||2
100 ||2
100 ||2
Common Mode
100 ||2
100 ||2
100 ||2
Input Operating
VS = 2.3 V to 5 V –VS + 1.9
+VS – 1.1 –VS + 1.9
+VS – 1.1 –VS + 1.9
+VS – 1.1
Voltage Range4
+VS – 1.2 –VS + 2.0
+VS – 1.2 –VS + 2.0
+VS – 1.2
Over Temperature
T = –40C to +85C –VS + 2.0
Input Operating
+VS – 1.2 –VS + 1.9
+VS – 1.2 –VS + 1.9
+VS – 1.2
Voltage Range
VS = 5 V to 18 V –VS + 1.9
+VS – 1.2 –VS + 2.0
+VS – 1.2 –VS + 2.0
+VS – 1.2
Over Temperature
T = –40C to +85C –VS + 2.0
N
Unit
REFERENCE INPUT
RIN
20
20
20
VIN+, VIN–, VREF = 0
50
60
50
60
50
60
IIN
+VS
–VS
+VS
–VS
+VS
Voltage Range
–VS
1  0.0001
1  0.0001
Gain to Output
1  0.0001
F Operating Range
VS = 2.3 V to 18 V 2.3
0.9
G Quiescent Current
H
Min
kHz
kHz
kHz
kHz
s
s
s
s
V/s
V/s
V/V
%
%
%
%
ppm
ppm
ppm
ppm
ppm/C
ppm/C
G ||pF
G ||pF
V
V
V
V
OUTPUTRL = 10 k
+VS – 1.2 –VS + 1.1
+VS – 1.2 –VS + 1.1
+VS – 1.2
Output Swing
VS = 2.3 V to 5 V –VS + 1.1
+VS – 1.3 –VS + 1.4
+VS – 1.3 –VS + 1.4
+VS – 1.3
Over Temperature
T = –40C to +85C –VS + 1.4
+VS – 1.4 –VS + 1.2
+VS – 1.4 –VS + 1.2
+VS – 1.4
Output Swing
VS = 5 V to 18 V –VS + 1.2
+VS – 1.5 –VS + 1.6
+VS – 1.5 –VS + 1.6
+VS – 1.5
Over Temperature
T = –40C to +85C –VS + 1.6
Short-Circuit Current
18
18
18
V
V
V
V
mA
TEMPERATURE RANGE
Specified Performance –40
+85
–40
+85
–40
+85
–40
+125
–40
+125
–40
+125
Operational4
°C
°C
NOTES
1
VS = 15 V, VREF = 0 V, TA = +25C, G = 1, RL = 2 k, unless otherwise noted.
2
Total RTI VOS = (VOSI) + (VOSO/G).
3
Does not include the effects of external resistor RG.
4
One input grounded. G = 1.
A-2
A statement at the top of the data sheet explains that
the listed specifications are typically @ TA = 25C,
VS = 15 V, and RL = 10 k, unless otherwise noted.
This tells the user that these are the normal operating
conditions under which the device is tested. Deviations
from these conditions might degrade (or improve) performance. For situations where deviations from the normal
conditions (such as a change in temperature) are likely,
the significant effects are usually indicated within the
specs.The statement at the top of the specifications table
also tells us what all numbers are unless noted; typical
is used to state that the manufacturer’s characterization
process has shown a number to be average; however,
individual devices may vary.
Instrumentation amplifiers designed for true rail-to-rail
operation have a few critical specifications that need to
be considered.Their input voltage range should allow the
in-amp to accept input signal levels that are close to the
power supply or ground. Their output swing should be
within 0.1 V of the supply line or ground. In contrast, a
typical dual-supply in-amp can swing only within 2 V or
more of the supply or ground. In 5 V single-supply data
acquisition systems, an extended output swing is vital
because it allows the full input range of the ADC to be
used, providing high resolution.
(B) Common-Mode Rejection
Common-mode rejection is a measure of the change in
output voltage when the same voltage is applied to both
inputs. CMR is normally specified as input, which allows
for in-amp gain. As the gain is increased, there will be a
higher output voltage for the same common-mode input
voltage. These specifications may be given for either a
full range input voltage change or for a specified source
imbalance in ohms.
Common-mode rejection ratio is a ratio expression,
while common-mode rejection is the logarithm of
that ratio. Both specifications are normally referred to
output (RTO).
That is,
CMRR =
Change inOutputVoltage
Change in Common-Mode InputVoltage
While
CMR = 20 Log10 CMRR
For example, a CMRR of 10,000 corresponds to a CMR
of 80 dB. For most in-amps, the CMR increases with
gain because most designs have a front-end configuration that rejects common-mode signals while amplifying
differential (i.e., signal) voltages.
Common-mode rejection is usually specified for a full
range common-mode voltage change at a given frequency,
and a specified imbalance of source impedance (e.g., l k
source unbalance, at 60 Hz).
(C) AC Common-Mode Rejection
As might be expected, an in-amp’s common-mode rejection does vary with frequency. Usually, CMR is specified
at dc or at very low input frequencies. At higher gains, an
in-amp’s bandwidth does decrease, lowering its gain and
introducing additional phase shift in its input stage.
Since any imbalance in phase shift in the differential input
stage will show up as a common-mode error, ac CMRR
will usually decrease with frequency. Figure A-1 shows
the CMR vs. frequency of the AD8221.
160
140
120
CMR (dB)
(A) Specifications (Conditions)
100
GAIN = 1000
GAIN = 100
GAIN = 1000
GAIN = 10
GAIN = 1
80
GAIN = 10
GAIN = 100
60
40
0.1
1
10
100
1k
10k
100k
1M
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure A-1. AD8221 CMR vs. frequency.
(D) Voltage Offset
Voltage offset specifications are often considered a
figure of merit for instrumentation amplifiers. While
any initial offset may be adjusted to zero through the
use of hardware or software, shifts in offset voltage due
to temperature variations are more difficult to correct.
Intelligent systems using a microprocessor can use a
temperature reference and calibration data to correct
for this, but there are many small signal, high gain applications that do not have this capability.
A-3
Voltage offset and drift comprise four separate error
definitions: room temperature (25C), input and output,
offset, and offset drift over temperature referred to both
input and output.
An in-amp should be regarded as a 2-stage amplifier with
both an input and an output section. Each section has
its own error sources. Because the errors of the output
section are multiplied by a fixed gain (usually 2), this
section is often the principal error source at low circuit
gains. When the in-amp is operating at higher gains, the
gain of the input stage is increased. As the gain is raised,
errors contributed by the input section are multiplied,
while output errors are reduced. Thus, at high gains, the
input stage errors dominate.
Input errors are those contributed by the input stage
alone; output errors are those due to the output section.
Input-related specifications are often combined and
classified together as referred to input (RTI) errors, while
all output-related specifications are considered referred to
output (RTO) errors. It is important to understand that
although these two specifications often provide numbers
that are not the same, either error term is correct because
each defines the total error in a different way.
For a given gain, an in-amp’s input and output errors
can be calculated using the following formulas:
Total Error, RTI = Input Error + (Output Error/Gain)
Total Error, RTO = (Gain  Input Error) + Output Error
Sometimes the specification page will list an error term as
RTI or RTO for a specified gain. In other cases, it is up
to the user to calculate the error for the desired gain.
As an example, the total voltage offset error of the
AD620A in-amp when it is operating at a gain of 10
can be calculated using the individual errors listed on
its specifications page. The (typical) input offset of the
AD620 (VOSI) is listed as 30 µV. Its output offset (VOSO)
is listed as 400 µV. The total voltage offset referred to
input (RTI) is equal to
Total RTI Error = VOSI + (VOSO/G) = 30 V +
(400 V/10) = 30 V + 40 V = 70 V
(E) Input Bias and Offset Currents
Input bias currents are those currents flowing into or
out of the input terminals of the in-amp. In-amps using
FET input stages have lower room temperature bias currents than their bipolar cousins, but FET input currents
double approximately every 11C. Input bias currents
can be considered a source of voltage offset error (i.e.,
input current flowing through a source resistance causes
a voltage offset). Any change in bias current is usually of
more concern than the magnitude of the bias current.
Input offset current is the difference between the two input
bias currents. It leads to offset errors in in-amps when source
resistances in the two input terminals are unequal.
Although instrumentation amplifiers have differential
inputs, there must be a return path for their bias currents to flow to common (ground).
If this return path is not provided, the bases (or gates)
of the input devices are left floating (unconnected), and
the in-amp’s output will rapidly drift either to common
or to the supply.
Therefore, when amplifying floating input sources such
as transformers (those without a center tap ground connection), ungrounded thermocouples, or any ac-coupled
input sources, there must still be a dc path from each
input to ground. A high value resistor of 1 M to 10 M
connected between each input and ground will normally
be all that is needed to correct this condition.
(F) Operating Voltage Range
A single-supply in-amp should have the same overall
operating voltage range whether it is using single or
dual supplies. That is, a single-supply in-amp, which is
specified to operate with dual-supply voltages from 1 V
to 18 V, should also operate over a 2 V to 36 V range
with a single supply, but this may not always be the case.
In fact, some in-amps, such as the AD623, will operate
to even lower equivalent voltage levels in single-supply
mode than with a dual-supply mode. For this reason, it
is always best to check the data sheet specifications.
(G) Quiescent Supply Current
The total voltage offset referred to the output (RTO)
is equal to
Total Offset Error RTO = (G (VOSI)) + VOSO =
(10 (30 V)) + 400 V = 700 V.
Note that the RTO error is 10 times greater in value
than the RTI error. Logically, it should be, because at a
gain of 10, the error at the output of the in-amp should
be 10 times the error at the input.
This specifies the quiescent or nonsignal power supply
current consumed by an in-amp within a specified
operating voltage range.
With the increasing number of battery-powered applications, device power consumption becomes a critical
design factor. Products such as the AD627 have a very
low quiescent current consumption of only 60 A, which
at 5 V is only 0.3 mW. Compare this power level to that
of an older, vintage dual-supply product, such as the
AD526. That device draws 14 mA with a 15 V supply
A-4
(30 V total) for a whopping 420 mW, 1400 times the
power consumption of the AD627. The implications for
battery life are dramatic.
With the introduction of products such as the AD627,
very impressive overall performance is achieved while only
microamps of supply current are consumed. Of course,
some trade-offs are usually necessary, so micropower
in-amps tend to have lower bandwidth and higher noise
than full power devices. The ability to operate rail-to-rail
from a single-supply voltage is an essential feature of any
micropower in-amp.
(H) Settling Time
Settling time is defined as the length of time required
for the output voltage to approach, and remain within, a
certain tolerance of its final value. It is usually specified
for a fast full-scale input step and includes output slewing time. Since several factors contribute to the overall
settling time, fast settling to 0.1% does not necessarily
mean proportionally fast settling to 0.01%. In addition,
settling time is not necessarily a function of gain. Some
of the contributing factors to long settling times include
slew rate limiting, underdamping (ringing), and thermal
gradients (long tails).
(I) Gain
These specifications relate to the transfer function of the
device. The product’s gain equation is normally listed at
the beginning of the specifications page.
The gain equation of the AD8221 is
Gain =
49,400 Ω
+1
RG
To select an RG for a given gain, solve the following
equation for RG:
RG =
49, 400 Ω
G −1
The following are samples of calculated resistance for
some common gains:
G = 1: RG =  (open circuit)
G = 9.998: RG = 5.49 k
G = 100: RG = 499 
G = 991: RG = 49.9 
Note that there will be a gain error if the standard resistance values are different from those calculated. In
addition, the tolerance of the resistors used (normally 1%
metal film) will also affect accuracy. There also will be
gain drift, typically 50 ppm/C to 100 ppm/C, if standard
resistors are used. Of course, the user must provide a very
clean (low leakage) circuit board to realize an accurate
gain of 1, since even a 200 M leakage resistance will
cause a gain error of 0.2%.
Normal metal film resistors are within 1% of their
stated value, which means that any two resistors could
be as much as 2% different in value from one another.
Thin film resistors in monolithic integrated circuits
have an absolute tolerance of only 20%. The matching
between resistors on the same chip, however, can be
excellent —typically better than 0.1%—and resistors
on the same chip will track each other thermally, so
gain drift over temperature is greatly reduced.
(J) Gain Range
Often specified as having a gain range of 1 to 1000, many
instrumentation amplifiers will often operate at higher
gains than 1000, but the manufacturer will not promise
a specific level of performance.
(K) Gain Error
In practice, as the gain resistor becomes increasingly
smaller, any errors due to the resistance of the metal runs
and bond wires inside the IC package become significant.
These errors, along with an increase in noise and drift,
may make higher gains impractical.
In 3-op amp and in-amp designs, both gain accuracy
and gain drift may suffer because the external resistor
does not exactly ratio match the IC’s internal resistors.
Moreover, the resistor chosen is usually the closest 1%
metal film value commonly available, rather than the
calculated resistance value; so this adds an additional
gain error. Some in-amps, such as the AD8230, use two
resistors to set gain. Assuming that gain is set solely by
the ratio of these two resistors in the IC, this can provide
potentially significant improvement in both gain accuracy
and drift. The best possible performance is provided by
monolithic in-amps that have all their resistors internal
to the IC, such as the AD621.
The number provided for this specification describes
maximum deviation from the gain equation. Monolithic
in-amps, such as the AD8221, have very low factorytrimmed gain errors. Although externally connected
gain networks allow the user to set the gain exactly, the
temperature coefficients of these external resistors and
the temperature differences between individual resistors
within the network all contribute to the circuit’s overall
gain error.
A-5
If the data eventually is digitized and fed to an intelligent
system (such as a microprocessor), it may be possible to
correct for gain errors by measuring a known reference
voltage and then multiplying by a constant.
(L) Nonlinearity
This makes trimming much easier to implement but may
result in nonlinearity errors of up to twice those attained
using the best straight line technique. This worst-case
error will occur when the transfer function is bowed in
one direction only.
Nonlinearity is defined as the deviation from a straight
line on the plot of an in-amp’s output voltage vs. input
voltage. Figure A-2 shows the transfer function of a
device with exaggerated nonlinearity.
Most linear devices, such as instrumentation amplifiers,
are specified for best straight line linearity. This needs
to be considered when evaluating the error budget for a
particular application.
The magnitude of this error is equal to
Regardless of the method used to specify nonlinearity,
the errors thus created are irreducible. That is to say,
these errors are neither fixed nor proportional to input
or output voltage and, therefore, cannot be reduced by
external adjustment.
Nonlinearity =
Actual Output – Calculated Output
Rated Full Scale Output Range
This deviation can be specified relative to any straight
line or to a specific straight line.There are two commonly
used methods of specifying this ideal straight line relative
to the performance of the device.
VOUT
GAIN
� + MAX
IDEAL
(STRAIGHT LINE)
ACTUAL
RESPONSE
–VIN FULL SCALE
VIN
� – MAX
(M) Gain vs. Temperature
These numbers provide both maximum and typical
deviations from the gain equation as a function of temperature. As stated in the Gain Error section (K), the TC
of an external gain resistor will never exactly match that
of other resistors within the IC package. Therefore, the
best performance over temperature is usually achieved by
in-amps using all internal gain resistors. Gain drift error
can be subtracted out in software by using a temperature
reference and calibration data.
(N) Key Specifications for Single-Supply In-Amps
+VIN FULL SCALE
There are some specifications that apply to single-supply
(i.e., rail-to-rail) in-amp products, which are of great
importance to designers powering in-amps from low
voltage, single-supply voltages.
� + MAX > � – MAX
� + MAX + � – MAX = K
Input and Output Voltage Swing
Figure A-2. Transfer function illustrating
exaggerated nonlinearity.
The best straight line method of defining nonlinearity
consists of measuring the peak positive and the peak
negative deviation and then adjusting the gain and offset
of the in-amp so that these maximum positive and negative
errors are equal. For monolithic in-amps, this is usually
accomplished by laser-trimming thin film resistors or
by other means. The best straight line method provides
impressive specifications, but it is much more difficult
to perform. The entire output signal range needs to be
examined before trimming to determine the maximum
positive and negative deviations.
The endpoint method of specifying nonlinearity requires
that any offset and/or gain calibrations are performed at
the minimum and maximum extremes of the output range.
Usually offset is trimmed at a very low output level, while
scale factor is trimmed near the maximum output level.
A single-supply in-amp needs to be able to handle
input voltages that are very close to the supply and
ground. In a typical dual-supply in-amp, the input
(and output) voltage range is within about 2 V of the
supply or ground. This becomes a real problem when
the device is powered from a 5 V supply, or can be
especially difficult when using the new 3.3 V standard.
A standard in-amp operating from a 5 V single-supply
line has only about 1 V of headroom remaining; with
a 3.3 V supply, it has virtually none.
Fortunately, a decent single-supply in-amp, such as the
AD627, will allow an output swing within 100 mV of
the supply and ground. The input level is somewhat less,
within 100 mV of ground and 1 V of the supply rail. In
critical applications, the reference terminal of the in-amp
can be moved off center to allow a symmetrical input
voltage range.
A-6
Appendix B
Amplifiers Selection Table
Part
Number Description
Supply
AD522
In-amp
Dual
AD524
Precision IA
Dual
AD526
Software-programmable amp
Dual
AD620
General-purpose IA
Dual
AD621
Precision IA
Dual
AD622Low cost IA
Dual AD623
Single-supply, rail-to-rail IA
Both
AD624
Precision IA
Dual
AD625
Programmable gain IA
Dual
AD626
Differential amp
Both
AD627
Micropower IA
Both
AD628
High CMV DA
Both
AD629
High CMV DA
Dual
AD8202 High CMV DA
Single
AD8203 High CMV DA
Single
AD8205 Single-supply differential amp
Single
AD8206 Single-supply differential amp
Single
AD8210 Differential amp
Single
AD8212Current sense amp
Single AD8213 Dual, current sense amp
Dual
AD8220Rail-to-rail JFET IA
Dual
AD8221 High performance IA
Dual
AD8221 BR grade specifications Dual
AD8222 High performance IA
Dual
AD8225 Fixed G = 5 IA
Dual
AD8230 Zero drift IA
Both
AD8250 Software-programmable, 10 MHz Dual
AD8251 Software-programmable, 10 MHz Dual
AD8553 Zero drift IA
Single
AD8555 Sensor amp
Single
AD8556 Sensor/filter amp
Single
AMP03
Precision differential amp
Dual
B-1
Supply Volts
Gain Setting
Min to Max
Method
65 to 618Resistor
66 to 618
Pin select
64.5 to 616.5
Software
62.3 to 618Resistor
62.3 to 618
Pin select
62.6 to 618Resistor
2.7 to 12Resistor
66 to 618
Pin select
66 to 618
3 resistors
2.4 to 12
Pin select
2.2 to 36Resistor
4.5 to 36
Pin/resistor
62.5 to 618
Fixed
3.5 to 12
Fixed
3.5 to 13
Fixed
4.5 to 5.5
Fixed
4.5 to 5.5
Fixed
4.5 to 5.5
Fixed
7 to 65Resistor
4.5 to 5.5
Fixed
62.3 to 618Resistor
62.3 to 618Resistor
62.3 to 618Resistor
62.3 to 618Resistor
61.7 to 618
Fixed
8 to 16Resistor
65 to 615
Software
65 to 615
Software
1.8 to 5.5Resistor
2.7 to 5.5
Software
2.7 to 5.5
Software
66 to 618
Fixed
Gain Range
Min to Max
1 to 1000
1 to 1000
1 to 16
1 to 10,000
10 and 100
1 to 1000
1 to 1000
1 to 1000
1 to 10,000
10 and 100
5 to 1000
0.1 to 100
G=1
G = 20
G = 14
G = 50
G = 20
G = 20
Adjustable
Gain = 20
1 to 1000
1 to 1000
1 to 1000
1 to 1000
G=5
2 to 1000
G = 1, 2, 5, 10
G = 1, 2, 4, 8
0.1 to 10,000
70 to 1280
70 to 1280
G=1
Amplifiers Selection Table (continued)
Part
CMRR at 60 Hz
Number
G = 1, G = 1000 Min
AD522
75 dB1, 100 dB2
AD524
70 dB, 110 dB
AD526N/A
AD620
73 dB, 110 dB
AD621
93 dB, 110 dB5
AD622
66 dB, 103 dB
AD623
70 dB, 105 dB
AD624
70 dB, 110 dB7
AD625
70 dB, 110 dB
AD626
55 dB5
AD627
77 dB8
AD628
75 dB
AD629
77 dB
AD8202
82 dB9
AD8203
82 dB10
AD8205
78 dB11, 12
AD8206
76 dB9, 11
AD8210
100 dB9
AD8212
90 dB13
AD8213
90 dB13
AD8220
90 dB13, 116 dB13
AD8221
80 dB, 130 dB
AD8221
90 dB, 140 dB
AD8222
80 dB, 130 dB
AD8225
86 dB8
AD8230
110 dB14
AD8250
80 dB, 100 dB
AD8251
80 dB, 100 dB
AD8553
100 dB, 120 dB15
AD8555
80 dB16, 96 dB17
AD8556
80 dB16, 94 dB17
AMP03
85 dB18
NOTES
1
DC to 30 Hz
2
DC to 1 Hz
3
Min BW at G = 100
4
Typ BW at G = 16
5
CMRR at gains of 10 and 100
6
Total offset voltage RTI at G = 100
7
At Gain = 500
8
At Gain = 5
9
At Gain = 20
Bandwidth
G = 10 Typ
3 kHz3
400 kHz
350 kHz4
800 kHz
800 kHz
800 kHz
100 kHz
400 kHz
400 kHz
100 kHz
30 kHz
600 kHz
500 kHz
50 kHz9
60 kHz10
50 kHz12
100 kHz9
500 kHz9
450 kHz9
450 kHz9
1 MHz
562 kHz
562 kHz
750 kHz
900 kHz8
2 kHz
10,000 kHz
10,000 kHz
1 kHz
700 kHz16
700 kHz16
3000 kHz18
VNOISE p-p RTI 1 to
10 Hz Typ G = 100
4 mV
0.3 mV
3 mV
0.28 mV
0.28 mV
0.3 mV
2 mV
0.3 mV
0.3 mV
2 mV
1.2 mV8
15 mV
15 mV
10 mV9
10 mV10
15 mV12
15 mV12
8 mV
15 mV12
10 mV12
0.8 mV
0.25 mV
0.25 mV
0.25 mV
1.5 mV8
3 mV
0.4 mV
0.4 mV
0.7 mV
0.5 mV
0.5 mV
2 mV18
10
At Gain = 14
DC to 20 kHz
12
At Gain = 50
13
Typical
14
At Gain of 10 to 1000
15
At Gain = 100
16
At Gain = 70
17
At Gain = 1280
18
At Gain = 1
11
B-2
Input Offset
Voltage
400 mV 250 mV 1500 mV
125 mV
125 mV6
125 mV
200 mV
200 mV
200 mV
2500 mV
200 mV
1500 mV
1000 mV
1000 mV
1000 mV
2000 mV
2000 mV
1000 mV
1000 mV
2000 mV
0.8 mV
60 mV
25 mV
120 mV
325 mV
10 mV
100 mV
100 mV
20 mV
10 mV
10 mV
400 mV18
Temperature
Range (8C)
–55 to +125
–55 to +125
–40 to +85
–55 to +125
–55 to +125
–40 to +85
–40 to +85
–55 to +125
–40 to +85
–40 to +85
–40 to +85
–40 to +85
–40 to +85
–40 to +125
–40 to +125
–40 to +125
–40 to +125
–40 to +150
–40 to +125
–40 to +125
–40 to +85
–40 to +125
–40 to +125
–40 to +85
–40 to +85
–40 to +125
–40 to +125
–40 to +125
–40 to +85
–40 to +125
–40 to +140
–40 to +85
Index
A
AC CMR vs. frequency, table, 5-20
AC input coupling, 5-2
AD620:
closed-loop gain vs. frequency, 3-4
CMR vs. frequency, 3-4
for EKG monitor transducer, 6-23
gain nonlinearity, 3-5
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
industry standard, 3-2, 3-3
input circuit, 5-6
for load cell transducer, 6-23
low power in-amp, 6-20
monolithic in-amp, 5-10
for photodiode sensor transducer, 6-23
pin configuration, 3-3
for RTD transducer, 6-23
simplified schematic, 3-4
small signal pulse response, 3-5
for thermistor transducer, 6-23
for thermocouple transducer, 6-23
AD620 series:
input circuit diagram, 5-6
RFI circuit, 5-15
AD621:
closed-loop gain vs. frequency, 3-7
CMR vs. frequency, 3-7
for EKG monitor transducer, 6-23
gain nonlinearity, 3-7
greater accuracy than AD620, 3-6
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
for load cell transducer, 6-23
monolithic in-amp, 5-11
for photodiode sensor transducer, 6-23
for RTD transducer, 6-23
simplified schematic, 3-6
small signal pulse response, 3-7
for thermistor transducer, 6-23
for thermocouple transducer, 6-23
AD622:
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
low cost:
closed-loop gain vs. frequency,
3-5, 3-6
CMR vs. frequency, 3-5
gain nonlinearity, 3-5
for photodiode sensor transducer, 6-23
AD623:
3-op amp circuit basis, 3-17
closed-loop gain vs. frequency, 3-18
CMR vs. frequency, 3-18
composite:
circuits, 6-4, 5
CMR, 6-4
driving ADC, circuit, 6-5
for EKG monitor transducer, 6-23
gain nonlinearity, 3-18
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
input architecture, 5-6
input circuit, 5-6
for photodiode sensor transducer, 6-23
rail-to-rail, 5-1
RFI filter, 5-16
RFI suppression circuit, 5-16
for RTD transducer, 6-23
simplified schematic, 3-17
single-supply data circuit, 6-20
small signal pulse response, 3-18
for thermistor transducer, 6-23
for thermocouple transducer, 6-23
AD626:
for current sense (shunt) transducer, 6-23
differential amplifier:
single- or dual-supply, 4-7, 4-8
CMR ratio, 4-8
gains, 4-8
signal pulse response, 4-8
simplified schematic, 4-8
for level sensor transducer, 6-23
AD627:
classic bridge circuit, 6-19
closed-loop gain vs. frequency, 3-20
CMR vs. frequency, 2-6, 3-19
for EKG monitor transducer, 6-23
feedback loops, 3-19
gain, equation, 3-19
gain nonlinearity, 3-20
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
input circuit, 5-6
low power, 6-25, 6-26
monolithic 2-op amp in-amp, 2-5, 2-6
for photodiode sensor transducer, 6-23
RFI suppression circuit, 5-15
for RTD transducer, 6-23
simplified schematic, 3-19
small signal pulse response, 3-20
for thermistor transducer, 6-23
for thermocouple transducer, 6-23
AD628:
bandwidth gain block, 6-11
block diagram, 1-5
for current sense (shunt) transducer, 6-23
difference amplifier, 6-13
differential scaling amplifier, 6-6, 6-7
high common-mode voltage difference amplifier,
4-6, 4-7
circuit connections, 4-6
CMRR vs. frequency, 4-7
gain adjustment, 4-6, 4-7
large signal frequency response, 4-7
C-1
simplified schematic, 4-6
small signal frequency response, 4-7
for level sensor transducer, 6-23
low gain, circuit, 6-7
precision gain block:
circuit, 6-6
gain of –10, circuit, 6-10
gain of +1, circuit, 6-11
gain of +10, circuit, 6-9
gain of +11, circuit, 6-10
high CMR, 6-6
no external components, 6-9
AD629:
for current sense (shunt) transducer, 6-23
difference amplifier, 1-5, 1-8, 6-16
high common-mode range, 6-12
high common-mode voltage, 6-17
high voltage measurement, 6-2
circuit, 6-2
for level sensor transducer, 6-23
monolithic difference amplifier, 2-1
for thermistor transducer, 6-23
unity-gain difference amplifier, 4-8
CMR vs. frequency, 4-9
connection diagram, 4-9
AD822, unity-gain inverter, 6-20
AD8130:
high frequency differential receiver/amplifier:
block diagram, 4-9
CMR vs. frequency, 4-9, 4-10
frequency response vs. supply voltage, 4-10
summing circuit:
frequency response, 6-16
performance photo, 6-16
AD8200 family, current sensing difference amplifier, 4-2
AD8202:
for current sense (shunt) transducer, 6-23
current sensing difference amplifier:
connection diagram, 4-2
simplified schematic, 4-2
two-stage system architecture, 4-3
high-side current measurement, 6-18
AD8203:
current sensing difference amplifier:
gain of 14, 4-2
two-stage system architecture, 4-3
AD8205:
for current sense (shunt) transducer, 6-23
current sensing difference amplifier, gain of 50, 4-2
difference amplifier:
single-supply, 4-3, 4-4
CMRR, 4-3
simplified schematic, 4-3
AD8206, difference amplifier, gain and power
consumption, 4-4
AD8210:
current shunt amplifier, high common-mode input,
4-1
difference amplifier:
CMRR vs. frequency and temperature, 4-5
current shunt monitor IC, block diagram, 4-4
motor control application, 6-19
AD8220:
CMRR vs. frequency, 3-8
connection diagram, 3-8
for EKG monitor transducer, 6-23
FET input, gain-programmable, 3-8
JFET in-amp, input circuit, 5-7
JFET input circuit, 5-7
for photodiode sensor transducer, 6-23
AD8221:
bridge circuit, 1-1
characteristics, 3-2 to 3-3
closed-loop gain vs. frequency, 3-3
CMRR, A-1
CMR vs. frequency, 3-3, A-3
CMRR specification, 3-3
dynamic response, A-2
for EKG monitor transducer, 6-23
filter circuits, 5-13, 5-16, 5-19
gain, A-2
gain bandwidth, 3-2
gain equation, A-5
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
input, A-2
input circuit, 5-5
input current, A-1
for load cell transducer, 6-23
low noise device, 5-5
noise, A-1
output, A-2
for photodiode sensor transducer, 6-23
pinout, 3-3
power supply, A-2
reference input, A-2
for RTD transducer, 6-23
simplified schematic, 3-2
specifications, A-1
table, A-1 to A-2
in strain gage, high CMRR, 6-5
temperature range, A-2
for thermistor transducer, 6-23
for thermocouple transducer, 6-23
voltage offset, A-1
AD8222:
dual in-amp:
connection diagram, 3-3
differential output performance, 3-3
for EKG monitor transducer, 6-23
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
input circuit, 5-5
for load cell transducer, 6-23
for photodiode sensor transducer, 6-23
for thermocouple transducer, 6-23
true differential output in-amp, 6-1
C-2
AD8225:
for EKG monitor transducer, 6-23
input circuit, 5-5
for level sensor transducer, 6-23
for load cell transducer, 6-23
monolithic, 3-16, 5-11
CMR vs. frequency, 3-16
gain nonlinearity, 3-16
simplified schematic, 3-16
RFI filter circuit, 5-16
for RTD transducer, 6-23
for thermistor transducer, 6-23
AD8230:
auto-zeroing, 3-8 to 3-12
CMR, 3-12
connection diagram, 3-8
gain setting, 3-12
gain vs. frequency, 3-12
internal workings, 3-9 to 3-12
signal sampling rate, 3-9
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
input circuit, 5-6
for load cell transducer, 6-23
for RTD transducer, 6-23
for thermocouple transducer, 6-23
zero-drift, input circuitry, 5-6
AD8250:
gain-programmable, 3-20
data acquisition, 3-20
medical applications, 3-20
schematic, 3-20
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
input circuit, 5-7
for RTD transducer, 6-23
AD8251:
gain-programmable, 3-20
data acquisition, 3-20
medical applications, 3-20
schematic, 3-20
for Hall effect magnetic transducer, 6-23
for RTD transducer, 6-23
AD8553:
auto-zeroing:
connection diagram, 3-13
current-mode, 3-12, 3-13
schematic, 3-13
chopper, 3-13
for EKG monitor transducer, 6-23
for level sensor transducer, 6-23
precision current source:
circuit, 6-3
integrator, 6-3
low frequency differential output, 6-3
zero-drift, input circuit, 5-7
AD8555:
auto-zeroing/chopper, 3-13
closed-loop gain vs. frequency,
3-15
CMRR vs. frequency, 3-15
schematic, 3-14
for load cell transducer, 6-23
for photodiode sensor transducer, 6-23
for RTD transducer, 6-23
RFI filter circuit, 5-17
sensor amplifier, 5-17
zero-drift:
input circuit, 5-8
sensor applications, 5-8
zero-drift, sensor signal amplifier, 3-13 to 3-15
connection diagram, 3-13
AD8556:
for load cell transducer, 6-23
on-chip EMI/RFI filter:
block diagram, 5-17
common-mode RFI/EMI, test circuit, 5-18
dc input offset values, 5-18
dc offset shift, 5-18
differential-mode EMI/RFI, test circuit, 5-18
for RTD transducer, 6-23
input circuit, 5-8
sensor applications, 5-8
zero-drift sensor signal amplifier, 3-13
block diagram, 3-15
EMI/RFI filters, 3-15
ADC:
high level interface, 6-13, 6-14
interface circuit:
single-supply, 6-13‑6-14
common-mode input, 6-14
SNR, 6-14
matching in-amp circuits, 7-1 to 7-8
recommended for use with in-amps, tables, 7-2 to 7-6
requirements, calculation, 7-1
system resolution vs. converter resolution and
preamp gain, table, 7-1
ADuC812, 12-bit ADC, embedded microcontroller, 6-26
AMP03:
differential amplifier, 7-8
monolithic unity-gain difference amplifier:
closed-loop gain vs. frequency, 4-5
CMRR vs. frequency, 4-5
functional block diagram, 4-5
high CMRR vs. frequency and temperature, 4-5
small signal pulse response, 4-6
Auto-zeroing in-amp, 3-8 to 3-15
B
Bandwidth, 1-8, 1-9
Bessel filter, values, 5-22
Bipolar bridge, low dropout, driver, 6-20
Bridge:
applications, 6-19, 6-20
using ac excitation, 6-5
Bridge circuit, 5-13
Butterworth filter, values, 5-22
C-3
C
Cable, shielded, 6-24
Cable termination, 5-5
CCD imaging, 7-7
imaging equipment, 1-6
Chebychev filter, values, 5-22
Chopper in-amp, 3-13
Circuit:
bridge:
3-op amp CMR, 1-4
3-op amp in-amp, CMR, 1-4
bridge preamp, 1-1
Classic bridge circuit, 6-19
CMR, 1-1 to 1-5, 1-7, A-3
AC, A-3
in-amp, A-3
common-mode voltage, 1-2
dc values, 1-3
in-amp, 1-7, A-3
op amp vs. in-amp, 1-3, 1-4
signal amplification, 1-1 to 1-3
trimming, 5-23
CMRR, A-3
circuit, degradation, 2-1
definition, 1-2
equation, 1-2
in-amp, A-3
increase proportional to gain, 2-3
CMV, 1-2
Common-mode filter:
conventional, 5-19
with X2Y capacitor, 5-19
Common-mode gain, 1-2
Common-mode rejection, see CMR
Common-mode rejection ratio, see CMRR
Common-mode RF choke, for in-amp RFI filter, 5-20
Common-mode voltage, 1-1, 1-2
in op amp circuit, 1-3
Composite in-amp:
circuit, 6-4
CMR, 6-4
CMR at gain of 2, 6-4
CMR at gain of 100, 6-4
Composite in-amp circuit:
high frequency CMR, 6-3 to 6-5
at various gains, circuits, 6-4
Controlling, 1-6
in-amp, 1-6
Conversion, differential to single-ended, 1-9
Current sense transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
Current sensor interface, 6-24, 6-25
Current transmitter, circuit, 6-12
D
Data acquisition, 1-5
DC return path, diagrams, 5-2
Decoupling, 5-1
Difference amp:
high voltage measurement, 6-1 to 6-5
monolithic, 4-1 to 4-10
table, 4-1
Difference amplifier, 6-16
applications circuit, 6-1 to 6-26
block diagram, 1-5
circuit, 1-5
IC, 1-5
nonlinearity vs. voltage, 6-17
selection table, B-1
use, 1-5, 1-6
Differential input circuit:
single-pole low-pass filter, 6-6
2-pole low-pass filter, 6-8
Differential output, circuit, 6-1
Differential signal voltage, 1-1
Digi-Key part # PS1H102GND, 5-14
Diode, leakage, 5-9
E
ECG:
monitor transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
schematic, 6-22
EKG, see ECG
Electrostatic discharge, see ESD
Error, calculations, 5-12
ESD:
input protection, 5-5
overload protection, 5-7
External CMR, performance, 5-23
External gain resistor, thermal gradient, error source, 5-11
External protection diodes, 5-8
F
Fast Schottky barrier rectifier, 5-9
Filter:
common-mode, using X2Y capacitors, 5-19
common-mode bandwidth, 5-14
component values, corner frequencies, tables, 6-9
differential:
bandwidths, 5-13, 5-14
basic circuit, 5-13
low-pass, to improve SNR, 5-21, 5-22
RFI, 5-13, 5-16 to 5-18
2-pole low-pass, frequency response, 6-8
Float sensor transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
G
Gain, 1-8
buffered subtractor circuit, 2-2
Gain drift, minimizing, 5-9
Gain error, A-5, A-6
input signal level differences, 5-10
Gain range, A-5
Gain resistor:
error source, 5-11
required value, table, 3-18
Gain vs. temperature, A-6
C-4
H
Hall effect magnetic transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
High frequency differential receiver/amplifier, 4-9, 4-10
High-side current sense, 6-19
High speed data acquisition, 7-7
High speed signal conditioning, 1-6
High voltage:
measurement:
methods, circuits, 6-1
new system:
circuit, 6-2
cross plot, 6-2
nonlinearity error, 6-2
performance, 6-2
High voltage monitor, circuit, 6-16
I
Impedance, high input, 1-8
In-amp:
2-op amp, 2-4 to 2-6
3-op amp, 2-2 to 2-4
CMR trim circuit, 5-23
feedback resistors, design, 5-10
3-op amp bridge circuit, CMR, 1-4
ac-coupled circuit, 5-2
ac input coupling, recommended component values,
table, 5-4
advantages, 1-7
application, 5-1 to 5-23
applications circuit, 6-1 to 6-26
auto-zeroing, 3-8 to 3-15
basics, 1-1 to 1-9
bipolar input stages, higher CMR, 2-3
buffers ADC, dc correction, 7-7
characteristics, 1-7 to 1-9
circuit:
CMR, 6-4
matched to ADCs, 7-1 to 7-8
CMR, 1-7
composite, circuit, 6-4
dc accuracy, design issues, 5-9, 5-10
definition, 1-1
differential output circuit, 6-1
differential vs. common-mode input signals,
circuit, 1-6
dual-supply operation, 5-1
external protection diodes, 5-9
external resistor, 1-7
fixed gain, dc performance, 5-11
functional block diagram, 1-6
high performance, 3-2 to 3-5
high quality, definition, 1-7 to 1-9
high speed, high performance circuit, 7-8
input characteristics, 1-2
input ground return, 5-2, 5-3
input protection basics, 5-5 to 5-9
internal characteristics, 2-1 to 2-6
low noise, 1-8
low power, single-supply, 3-19, 3-20
low power, output buffering, 6-25
micropower, RFI circuit, 5-15
monolithic, 3-1 to 3-20
advantages, 3-1
design, 3-2 to 3-8
for single-supply operation, 3-17, 3-18
monolithic difference, 4-1 to 4-10
multiplexed, 7-7
operating gains, table, 2-4
output, 1-7
buffer, for low impedance, 5-3
power supply bypassing, diagram, 5-1
rail-to-rail output swing, diagram, 5-1
reference input:
CMR error, 5-4
driving, 5-4
RFI rejection measurement, circuit, 5-21
selection table, B-1, B-2
series protection resistor values, table, 5-8
single-supply:
input and output swing, 5-1
key specifications, A-6
single-supply operation, 5-1
specifications, A-1 to A-6
stability, 5-1
summary, table, 3-1
transducer interface application, 6-21
uses, 1-5, 1-6
vs. op amp, 3-1
differences, 1-1 to 1-4
Wheatstone bridge, 6-19
In-amp circuit, input buffers, CMR, 1-4
Input and output voltage swing, A-6
Input bias, 1-8, A-4
Input noise, 5-12
International rectifier SD101 series, 5-9
J
J-type thermocouple, 6-26
Johanson Dielectrics, X2Y capacitor, 5-19
Johnson noise, 5-5
L
Level sensor transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
Linearity, best straight line method, A-6
Load cell transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
Low-pass filter:
4-pole:
recommended component values, table, 5-22
values, 5-22
M
Medical ECG monitor circuit, 6-22
Medical instrumentation, 1-6
Micropower in-amp, RFI circuit, 5-15
Monitoring, 1-6
Monolithic difference in-amp, 4-1 to 4-10
applications, 4-1
C-5
N
Noise, 1-9
ground, 6-12, 6-13
low, 1-8
Noise error, 5-12
Nonlinearity, A-6
low, 1-8
Nyquist criteria, 7-8
O
Offset current, A-4
Offset current error, 1-8
Offset error, 5-12
Op amp:
CMR, 1-3
in-amp difference amplifier circuit, block diagram,
2-1
subtractor, as in-amp, 2-1
vs. in-amp, 1-1 to 1-5
OP27, transfer function, 6-13
OP177, integrator, 6-16
Operating voltage range, A-4
Output buffer, for low power in-amp, 6-25
Output swing, 1-9
Overload:
steady state, 5-5
transient, 5-5
P
Photodiode sensor transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
PID loop, integrator, 6-3
Power, 1-9
Power controlling, 1-6
Power supply bypassing, 5-1
Power supply decoupling, 5-1
Power vs. bandwidth, 1-9
Precision 48 V bus monitor:
circuit, 6-17
output vs. input linearity, 6-18
remote voltage measurement, circuit, 6-17
temperature drift, 6-18
Precision voltage-to-current converter, 6-24, 6-25
Proportional integral differential, see: PID
Pulse Engineering, common-mode choke, 5-20
Q
Quiescent supply current, A-4, A-5
R
Rail-to-rail input, 1-9
RC coupling component, selecting and matching, 5-3, 5-4
Receiver circuit, 6-26
Referred to input, see RTI
Referred to output, see RTO
Remote load sensing, circuit, 6-24
Resistance temperature detector transducer,
characteristics, table, 6-23
Resistor values:
for in-amps, table, 5-8
for various gains, table, 4-7
RFI:
circuit, diagram, 5-13
input filter component values, selection, 5-14
rectification error, reducing, 5-12 to 5-20
RFI attenuation, X2Y vs. conventional common-mode
filter, 5-19
RFI filter, 5-16 to 5-18
bandwidths, 5-13
design, 5-12 to 5-20
for in-amp, 5-17
RFI rectification:
error prevention, filter circuit, 5-13
error reduction, in-amp circuit, 5-12
RFI suppression, using common-mode RF choke, 5-20
RFI testing, 5-21
RTI, in-amp, A-4
RTI error, 5-11, 5-12
RTO, in-amp, A-4
RTO error, 5-11, 5-12
S
Schottky diode, 5-8, 5-9
Settling time, 5-23
in-amp, A-5
Signal-to-noise ratio, see SNR
Signal voltage, in op amp circuit, 1-3
Silicon diode, 5-8
Single-supply bridge configuration transducer,
characteristics, table, 6-23
Single-supply receiver, circuit, 6-26
Slew rate, in-amp, 1-9
Software programming, in-amp, 1-6
Specifications, in-amp, A-3
SSM2019, audio preamplifier, 6-26
SSM2141, differential line receiver, 6-26
SSM2143, differential line receiver, 6-26
Strain gage, measurement, with AC excitation, 6-5
Strain gage bridge transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
Subtractor amp, 4-1 to 4-10
Subtractor circuit:
buffered, diagram, 2-2
input buffering, diagram, 2-1
Summing amplifier:
circuit, 6-15
high input impedance, 6-15
high speed noninverting, 6-15 to 6-17
Switch:
high-side, 6-19
low-side, 6-18
C-6
T
Thermal EMF, 5-10
Thermal gradient, error source, 5-11
Thermal sensor transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
Thermistor transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
Thermocouple amplifier, single-supply in-amp, 6-26
Thermocouple effect, 5-10
Thermocouple transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
3-op amp in-amp, 2-2, 2-3
circuit, 2-2
CMR trim circuit, 5-23
design considerations, 2-3, 2-4
feedback resistors, gain error, circuit, 5-10
reduced CMV range, circuit, 2-3
Total error, A-4
Total noise, 5-12
Total offset error, A-4
Transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
Transfer function, nonlinearity, A-6
Transformer-coupled input, dc return path, diagram, 5-2
Transient, overload protection, 5-9
2-op amp in-amp:
architecture, 2-5
circuit, 2-4
common-mode design, 2-5, 2-6
limitations:
high CMR, 2-6
output swing, 2-5
transfer function, 2-4
V
Video applications, 1-6
Voltage:
common mode, 1-1
differential signal, 1-1
offset, 1-7
Voltage drift, lowest offset, design, 5-9, 5-10
Voltage offset, A-3, A-4
Voltage-to-current converter, 6-25
W
Weight measurement transducer, characteristics, table, 6-23
X
X2Y capacitor, 5-19
electrostatic model, 5-19
Z
Zener diode, 6-17
Zero-drift in-amp, 7-5, 7-6
C-7
Device Index
Product
Page
2N2222.............................................................. 6-17
AD520................................................................. 3-2
AD522......................................................... B-1, B-2
AD524.................................................. 3-3, B-1, B-2
AD526..................................................A-4, B-1, B-2
AD580................................................................. 2-5
AD584................................................................. 2-5
AD589............................................................... 6-20
AD620..... 3-1 to 3-6, 3-17, 5-6, 5-8, 5-10, 5-12, 5-15,
.......................5-20, 6-20, 6-23 to 6-25, A-4, B-1, B-2
AD620 series........................................ 3-2, 5-6, 5-15
AD620A......................................................5-12, A-4
AD620AR............................................................. 7-2
AD621..................... 1-8, 3-1, 3-6, 3-7, 5-6, 5-8, 5-11,
.................................................... 6-23, A-5, B-1, B-2
AD622.............. 3-1, 3-5, 3-6, 5-6, 5-8, 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD623................. 3-1, 3-17, 3-18, 5-1, 5-6, 5-8, 5-16,
..................... 6-4, 6-5, 6-20, 6-23, 6-24, A-4, B-1, B-2
AD623AR............................................................. 7-3
AD624......................................................... B-1, B-2
AD625......................................................... B-1, B-2
AD626.......... 4-1, 4-7, 4-8, 6-23, 6-24, 6-25, B-1, B-2
AD627.......................... 2-5, 2-6, 3-1, 3-19, 3-20, 5-6,
....................5-8, 5-15, 5-16, 6-19, 6-20, 6-23 to 6-26,
.................................................. A-4 to A-6, B-1, B-2
AD627AR............................................................. 7-4
AD628.........................1-5, 4-1, 4-6, 4-7, 6-6 to 6-11,
.......................................... 6-13, 6-14, 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD629.............. 1-5, 1-8, 2-1, 4-1, 4-8, 4-9, 6-2, 6-12,
.......................................... 6-16, 6-17, 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD630................................................................. 6-5
AD630AR............................................................. 6-5
AD704............................................................... 5-22
AD705...................................................... 6-24, 6-25
AD706............................................................... 5-22
AD820............................................................... 6-25
AD822............................................................... 6-20
AD823................................................................. 7-8
AD825................................................................. 7-8
AD830................................................................. 7-8
AD871................................................................. 7-8
AD7266......................................................... 7-7, 7-8
AD7321......................................................... 7-4, 7-5
AD7322......................................................... 7-7, 7-8
AD7323......................................................... 7-4, 7-5
AD7327......................................................... 7-4, 7-5
Product
Page
AD7450..................................................... 6-13, 6-14
AD7453/AD7457.................................................. 7-2
AD7466................................................................ 7-6
AD7476....................................................... 6-17, 7-6
AD7476A............................................................. 7-6
AD7610......................................................... 7-2, 7-4
AD7661................................................................ 7-3
AD7663......................................................... 7-2, 7-4
AD7685......................................... 6-22, 7-2, 7-5, 7-6
AD7687......................................................... 7-2, 7-5
AD7776.............................................................. 6-20
AD7862/AD7864.................................................. 7-3
AD7863/AD7865.................................................. 7-3
AD7866................................................................ 7-3
AD7890/AD7891/AD7892.................................... 7-3
AD7895................................................................ 7-2
AD7898-3............................................................ 7-4
AD7920................................................................ 7-4
AD7923/AD7927.................................................. 7-4
AD7940................................................................ 7-3
AD7942................................................................ 7-5
AD8130........................................4-1, 4-9, 4-10, 6-15
AD8130 series...................................................... 4-9
AD8200 family.............................................. 4-1, 4-2
AD8202............. 4-1 to 4-3, 6-18, 6-19, 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD8203....................................... 4-1 to 4-3, B-1, B-2
AD8205...............................4-1 to 4-4, 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD8206.......................................... 4-1, 4-4, B-1, B-2
AD8210...........................4-1, 4-4, 4-5, 6-19, B-1, B-2
AD8212................................................. 4-1, B-1, B-2
AD8213................................................. 4-1, B-1, B-2
AD8220..................................3-1, 3-8, 5-7, 5-8, 5-13,
................................................6-21 to 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD8220AR........................................................... 7-4
AD8221................. 1-1, 3-1 to 3-3, 5-5, 5-6, 5-8, 5-13,
.........................5-15, 5-16, 5-19, 6-3, 6-5, 6-23, 6-24,
........................................... A-1 to A-3, A-5, B-1, B-2
AD8221AR........................................................... 7-2
AD8222.... 3-1, 3-3, 5-5, 5-8, 5-13, 6-1, 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD8225....................... 3-1, 3-16, 5-5, 5-8, 5-11, 5-16,
..............................................6-3, 6-23, 7-3, B-1, B-2
AD8230...................... 3-1, 3-8 to 3-12, 5-6, 5-8, 6-23,
.............................................................A-5, B-1, B-2
AD8230RZ........................................................... 7-5
AD8250........... 3-1, 3-20, 5-7, 5-8, 6-23, 7-5, B-1, B-2
AD8251.................. 3-1, 3-20, 5-8, 6-23, 7-5, B-1, B-2
D-1
Product
Page
AD8553......................... 3-1, 3-12, 3-13, 5-7, 5-8, 6-3,
........................................................... 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD8553RM.......................................................... 7-6
AD8555...........................3-1, 3-13 to 3-15, 5-8, 5-17,
........................................................... 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD8555AR/AD8556ARZ...................................... 7-6
AD8556.............................. 3-1, 3-13, 3-15, 5-8, 5-17,
...................................................5-18, 6-23, B-1, B-2
AD8618..................................................... 6-21, 6-22
AD8641.............................................................. 6-24
AD8642.............................................................. 6-24
AD8643.............................................................. 6-24
AD8698.................................................. 2-1, 2-2, 2-4
AD9240................................................................ 7-8
ADR425............................................................. 6-17
ADR431.................................................... 6-13, 6-14
ADR435............................................................. 6-22
ADuC812........................................................... 6-26
AMP01............................................................... 6-24
AMP03..................... 4-1, 4-5, 4-6, 6-24, 7-8, B-1, B-2
OP27......................................................... 6-12, 6-13
OP177................................................................ 6-16
OP297................................................................ 5-22
OP497................................................................ 5-22
OP777AR........................................................... 6-17
OP1177.................................................. 2-1, 2-2, 6-5
OP2177.................................2-1, 2-2, 2-4, 6-21, 6-22
SSM2019........................................................... 6-26
SSM2141........................................................... 6-26
SSM2143........................................................... 6-26
D-2
Analog Devices, Inc.
Worldwide Headquarters
Analog Devices, Inc.
One Technology Way
P.O. Box 9106
Norwood, MA 02062-9106
U.S.A.
Tel: 781.329.4700
(800.262.5643,
U.S.A. only)
Fax: 781.461.3113
Analog Devices, Inc.
Europe Headquarters
Analog Devices, Inc.
Wilhelm-Wagenfeld-Str.6
80807 Munich
Germany
Tel: 49.89.76903.0
Fax: 49.89.76903.157
Analog Devices, Inc.
Japan Headquarters
Analog Devices, KK
New Pier Takeshiba
South Tower Building
1-16-1 Kaigan, Minato-ku,
Tokyo, 105-6891
Japan
Tel: 813.5402.8200
Fax: 813.5402.1064
Analog Devices, Inc.
Southeast Asia
Headquarters
Analog Devices
22/F One Corporate Avenue
222 Hu Bin Road
Shanghai, 200021
China
Tel: 86.21.5150.3000
Fax: 86.21.5150.3222
©2006 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved.
Trademarks and registered trademarks are the property
of their respective owners.
Printed in the U.S.A.
G02678-15-9/06(B)
www.analog.com/inamps